You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

16138 lines
435KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program.
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  173. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  174. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  175. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  176. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  177. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  178. @end example
  179. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  180. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  181. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  182. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  183. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  184. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  185. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  186. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  187. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  188. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  189. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  190. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  191. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  192. characters contained within it.
  193. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  194. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  195. @example
  196. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  197. @end example
  198. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  199. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  200. @example
  201. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  202. @end example
  203. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  204. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  205. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  206. @example
  207. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  208. @end example
  209. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  210. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  211. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  212. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  213. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  214. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  215. previous string will finally result in:
  216. @example
  217. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  218. @end example
  219. @chapter Timeline editing
  220. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  221. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  222. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  223. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  224. next filter in the filtergraph.
  225. The expression accepts the following values:
  226. @table @samp
  227. @item t
  228. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  229. @item n
  230. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  231. @item pos
  232. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  233. @item w
  234. @item h
  235. width and height of the input frame if video
  236. @end table
  237. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  238. to re-define the expression.
  239. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  240. rules.
  241. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  242. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  243. @example
  244. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  245. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  246. @end example
  247. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  248. @chapter Audio Filters
  249. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  250. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  251. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  252. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  253. build.
  254. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  255. @section acompressor
  256. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  257. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  258. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  259. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  260. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  261. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  262. but can also destroy a track completely).
  263. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  264. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  265. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  266. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  267. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  268. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  269. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  270. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  271. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  272. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  273. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  274. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  275. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  276. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  277. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  278. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  279. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  280. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  281. The filter accepts the following options:
  282. @table @option
  283. @item level_in
  284. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  285. @item threshold
  286. If a signal of second stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  287. reduction of the first stream.
  288. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  289. @item ratio
  290. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  291. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  292. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  293. @item attack
  294. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  295. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  296. @item release
  297. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  298. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  299. @item makeup
  300. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  301. Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
  302. @item knee
  303. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  304. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  305. @item link
  306. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  307. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  308. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  309. @item detection
  310. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  311. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  312. @item mix
  313. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  314. Range is between 0 and 1.
  315. @end table
  316. @section acrossfade
  317. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  318. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  319. The filter accepts the following options:
  320. @table @option
  321. @item nb_samples, ns
  322. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  323. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  324. silent. Default is 44100.
  325. @item duration, d
  326. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  327. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  328. for the accepted syntax.
  329. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  330. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  331. @item overlap, o
  332. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  333. @item curve1
  334. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  335. @item curve2
  336. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  337. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  338. @end table
  339. @subsection Examples
  340. @itemize
  341. @item
  342. Cross fade from one input to another:
  343. @example
  344. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  345. @end example
  346. @item
  347. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  348. @example
  349. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  350. @end example
  351. @end itemize
  352. @section adelay
  353. Delay one or more audio channels.
  354. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  355. The filter accepts the following option:
  356. @table @option
  357. @item delays
  358. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  359. At least one delay greater than 0 should be provided.
  360. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  361. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  362. @end table
  363. @subsection Examples
  364. @itemize
  365. @item
  366. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  367. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  368. @example
  369. adelay=1500|0|500
  370. @end example
  371. @end itemize
  372. @section aecho
  373. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  374. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  375. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  376. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  377. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  378. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  379. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  380. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  381. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  382. @table @option
  383. @item in_gain
  384. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  385. @item out_gain
  386. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  387. @item delays
  388. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  389. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  390. Default is @code{1000}.
  391. @item decays
  392. Set list of loudnesses of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  393. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  394. Default is @code{0.5}.
  395. @end table
  396. @subsection Examples
  397. @itemize
  398. @item
  399. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  400. @example
  401. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  402. @end example
  403. @item
  404. If delay is very short, then it sound like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  405. @example
  406. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  407. @end example
  408. @item
  409. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  410. @example
  411. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  412. @end example
  413. @item
  414. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  415. @example
  416. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  417. @end example
  418. @end itemize
  419. @section aemphasis
  420. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  421. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  422. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  423. this recording medium.
  424. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  425. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  426. The filter accepts the following options:
  427. @table @option
  428. @item level_in
  429. Set input gain.
  430. @item level_out
  431. Set output gain.
  432. @item mode
  433. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  434. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  435. @item type
  436. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  437. @table @option
  438. @item col
  439. select Columbia.
  440. @item emi
  441. select EMI.
  442. @item bsi
  443. select BSI (78RPM).
  444. @item riaa
  445. select RIAA.
  446. @item cd
  447. select Compact Disc (CD).
  448. @item 50fm
  449. select 50µs (FM).
  450. @item 75fm
  451. select 75µs (FM).
  452. @item 50kf
  453. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  454. @item 75kf
  455. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  456. @end table
  457. @end table
  458. @section aeval
  459. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  460. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  461. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  462. It accepts the following parameters:
  463. @table @option
  464. @item exprs
  465. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  466. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  467. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  468. output channels.
  469. @item channel_layout, c
  470. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  471. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  472. use by default the same input channel layout.
  473. @end table
  474. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  475. @table @option
  476. @item ch
  477. channel number of the current expression
  478. @item n
  479. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  480. @item s
  481. sample rate
  482. @item t
  483. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  484. @item nb_in_channels
  485. @item nb_out_channels
  486. input and output number of channels
  487. @item val(CH)
  488. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  489. @end table
  490. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  491. dedicated filter.
  492. @subsection Examples
  493. @itemize
  494. @item
  495. Half volume:
  496. @example
  497. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  498. @end example
  499. @item
  500. Invert phase of the second channel:
  501. @example
  502. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  503. @end example
  504. @end itemize
  505. @anchor{afade}
  506. @section afade
  507. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  508. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  509. @table @option
  510. @item type, t
  511. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  512. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  513. @item start_sample, ss
  514. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  515. effect. Default is 0.
  516. @item nb_samples, ns
  517. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  518. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  519. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  520. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  521. @item start_time, st
  522. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  523. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  524. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  525. for the accepted syntax.
  526. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  527. @item duration, d
  528. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  529. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  530. for the accepted syntax.
  531. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  532. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  533. the output audio will be silence.
  534. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  535. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  536. @item curve
  537. Set curve for fade transition.
  538. It accepts the following values:
  539. @table @option
  540. @item tri
  541. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  542. @item qsin
  543. select quarter of sine wave
  544. @item hsin
  545. select half of sine wave
  546. @item esin
  547. select exponential sine wave
  548. @item log
  549. select logarithmic
  550. @item ipar
  551. select inverted parabola
  552. @item qua
  553. select quadratic
  554. @item cub
  555. select cubic
  556. @item squ
  557. select square root
  558. @item cbr
  559. select cubic root
  560. @item par
  561. select parabola
  562. @item exp
  563. select exponential
  564. @item iqsin
  565. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  566. @item ihsin
  567. select inverted half of sine wave
  568. @item dese
  569. select double-exponential seat
  570. @item desi
  571. select double-exponential sigmoid
  572. @end table
  573. @end table
  574. @subsection Examples
  575. @itemize
  576. @item
  577. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  578. @example
  579. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  580. @end example
  581. @item
  582. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  583. @example
  584. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  585. @end example
  586. @end itemize
  587. @section afftfilt
  588. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  589. @table @option
  590. @item real
  591. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  592. by '|'. Default is "1".
  593. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  594. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  595. output channels.
  596. @item imag
  597. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  598. separated by '|'. If not set, @var{real} option is used.
  599. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  600. constants:
  601. @table @option
  602. @item sr
  603. sample rate
  604. @item b
  605. current frequency bin number
  606. @item nb
  607. number of available bins
  608. @item ch
  609. channel number of the current expression
  610. @item chs
  611. number of channels
  612. @item pts
  613. current frame pts
  614. @end table
  615. @item win_size
  616. Set window size.
  617. It accepts the following values:
  618. @table @samp
  619. @item w16
  620. @item w32
  621. @item w64
  622. @item w128
  623. @item w256
  624. @item w512
  625. @item w1024
  626. @item w2048
  627. @item w4096
  628. @item w8192
  629. @item w16384
  630. @item w32768
  631. @item w65536
  632. @end table
  633. Default is @code{w4096}
  634. @item win_func
  635. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  636. @item overlap
  637. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  638. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  639. @end table
  640. @subsection Examples
  641. @itemize
  642. @item
  643. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  644. @example
  645. afftfilt="1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1)"
  646. @end example
  647. @end itemize
  648. @anchor{aformat}
  649. @section aformat
  650. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  651. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  652. It accepts the following parameters:
  653. @table @option
  654. @item sample_fmts
  655. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  656. @item sample_rates
  657. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  658. @item channel_layouts
  659. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  660. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  661. for the required syntax.
  662. @end table
  663. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  664. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  665. @example
  666. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  667. @end example
  668. @section agate
  669. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  670. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  671. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  672. and divide it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  673. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  674. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  675. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  676. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  677. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  678. has to raise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  679. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  680. @table @option
  681. @item level_in
  682. Set input level before filtering.
  683. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  684. @item range
  685. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  686. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  687. @item threshold
  688. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  689. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  690. @item ratio
  691. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  692. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  693. @item attack
  694. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  695. reduction stops.
  696. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  697. @item release
  698. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  699. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  700. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  701. @item makeup
  702. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  703. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  704. @item knee
  705. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  706. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  707. @item detection
  708. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  709. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  710. @item link
  711. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  712. the reduction.
  713. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  714. @end table
  715. @section alimiter
  716. The limiter prevents input signal from raising over a desired threshold.
  717. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  718. It means that there is a small delay after signal is processed. Keep in mind
  719. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  720. The filter accepts the following options:
  721. @table @option
  722. @item level_in
  723. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  724. @item level_out
  725. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  726. @item limit
  727. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  728. @item attack
  729. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  730. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  731. @item release
  732. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  733. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  734. @item asc
  735. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  736. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  737. time.
  738. @item asc_level
  739. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  740. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  741. @item level
  742. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  743. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  744. @end table
  745. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  746. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  747. @section allpass
  748. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  749. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  750. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  751. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  752. The filter accepts the following options:
  753. @table @option
  754. @item frequency, f
  755. Set frequency in Hz.
  756. @item width_type
  757. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  758. @table @option
  759. @item h
  760. Hz
  761. @item q
  762. Q-Factor
  763. @item o
  764. octave
  765. @item s
  766. slope
  767. @end table
  768. @item width, w
  769. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  770. @end table
  771. @anchor{amerge}
  772. @section amerge
  773. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  774. The filter accepts the following options:
  775. @table @option
  776. @item inputs
  777. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  778. @end table
  779. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  780. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  781. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  782. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  783. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  784. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  785. channels.
  786. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  787. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  788. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  789. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  790. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  791. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  792. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  793. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  794. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  795. shortest.
  796. @subsection Examples
  797. @itemize
  798. @item
  799. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  800. @example
  801. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  802. @end example
  803. @item
  804. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  805. @example
  806. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  807. @end example
  808. @end itemize
  809. @section amix
  810. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  811. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  812. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  813. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  814. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  815. For example
  816. @example
  817. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  818. @end example
  819. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  820. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  821. It accepts the following parameters:
  822. @table @option
  823. @item inputs
  824. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  825. @item duration
  826. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  827. @table @option
  828. @item longest
  829. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  830. @item shortest
  831. The duration of the shortest input.
  832. @item first
  833. The duration of the first input.
  834. @end table
  835. @item dropout_transition
  836. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  837. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  838. @end table
  839. @section anequalizer
  840. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  841. It accepts the following parameters:
  842. @table @option
  843. @item params
  844. This option string is in format:
  845. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  846. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  847. @table @option
  848. @item chn
  849. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  850. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  851. @item cf
  852. Set central frequency for band.
  853. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  854. @item w
  855. Set band width in hertz.
  856. @item g
  857. Set band gain in dB.
  858. @item f
  859. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  860. @table @samp
  861. @item 0
  862. Butterworth, this is default.
  863. @item 1
  864. Chebyshev type 1.
  865. @item 2
  866. Chebyshev type 2.
  867. @end table
  868. @end table
  869. @item curves
  870. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  871. in video stream.
  872. @item size
  873. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  874. @item mgain
  875. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  876. Setting this to reasonable value allows to display gain which is derived from
  877. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  878. when both are activated.
  879. @item fscale
  880. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  881. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  882. @item colors
  883. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  884. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  885. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  886. @end table
  887. @subsection Examples
  888. @itemize
  889. @item
  890. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  891. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  892. @example
  893. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  894. @end example
  895. @end itemize
  896. @subsection Commands
  897. This filter supports the following commands:
  898. @table @option
  899. @item change
  900. Alter existing filter parameters.
  901. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  902. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  903. error is returned.
  904. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  905. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  906. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  907. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  908. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  909. @end table
  910. @section anull
  911. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  912. @section apad
  913. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  914. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  915. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  916. A description of the accepted options follows.
  917. @table @option
  918. @item packet_size
  919. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  920. @item pad_len
  921. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  922. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  923. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  924. @item whole_len
  925. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  926. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  927. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  928. with @option{pad_len}.
  929. @end table
  930. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} option is
  931. set, the filter will add silence to the end of the input stream
  932. indefinitely.
  933. @subsection Examples
  934. @itemize
  935. @item
  936. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  937. @example
  938. apad=pad_len=1024
  939. @end example
  940. @item
  941. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  942. the input with silence if required:
  943. @example
  944. apad=whole_len=10000
  945. @end example
  946. @item
  947. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  948. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  949. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  950. option:
  951. @example
  952. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  953. @end example
  954. @end itemize
  955. @section aphaser
  956. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  957. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  958. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  959. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  960. @table @option
  961. @item in_gain
  962. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  963. @item out_gain
  964. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  965. @item delay
  966. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  967. @item decay
  968. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  969. @item speed
  970. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  971. @item type
  972. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  973. It accepts the following values:
  974. @table @samp
  975. @item triangular, t
  976. @item sinusoidal, s
  977. @end table
  978. @end table
  979. @section apulsator
  980. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  981. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  982. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  983. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  984. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  985. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  986. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  987. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  988. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  989. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  990. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  991. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  992. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  993. The filter accepts the following options:
  994. @table @option
  995. @item level_in
  996. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  997. @item level_out
  998. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  999. @item mode
  1000. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1001. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1002. @item amount
  1003. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1004. @item offset_l
  1005. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1006. @item offset_r
  1007. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1008. @item width
  1009. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1010. @item timing
  1011. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1012. @item bpm
  1013. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1014. is set to bpm.
  1015. @item ms
  1016. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1017. is set to ms.
  1018. @item hz
  1019. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1020. if timing is set to hz.
  1021. @end table
  1022. @anchor{aresample}
  1023. @section aresample
  1024. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1025. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1026. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1027. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1028. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1029. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1030. The filter accepts the syntax
  1031. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1032. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1033. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1034. ffmpeg-resampler manual for the complete list of supported options.
  1035. @subsection Examples
  1036. @itemize
  1037. @item
  1038. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1039. @example
  1040. aresample=44100
  1041. @end example
  1042. @item
  1043. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1044. samples per second compensation:
  1045. @example
  1046. aresample=async=1000
  1047. @end example
  1048. @end itemize
  1049. @section asetnsamples
  1050. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1051. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1052. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1053. signal its end.
  1054. The filter accepts the following options:
  1055. @table @option
  1056. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1057. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1058. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1059. Default value is 1024.
  1060. @item pad, p
  1061. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1062. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1063. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1064. @end table
  1065. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1066. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1067. @example
  1068. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1069. @end example
  1070. @section asetrate
  1071. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1072. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1073. The filter accepts the following options:
  1074. @table @option
  1075. @item sample_rate, r
  1076. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1077. @end table
  1078. @section ashowinfo
  1079. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1080. The input audio is not modified.
  1081. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1082. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1083. The following values are shown in the output:
  1084. @table @option
  1085. @item n
  1086. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1087. @item pts
  1088. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1089. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1090. @item pts_time
  1091. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1092. @item pos
  1093. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1094. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1095. @item fmt
  1096. The sample format.
  1097. @item chlayout
  1098. The channel layout.
  1099. @item rate
  1100. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1101. @item nb_samples
  1102. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1103. @item checksum
  1104. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1105. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1106. @item plane_checksums
  1107. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1108. @end table
  1109. @anchor{astats}
  1110. @section astats
  1111. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1112. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1113. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1114. It accepts the following option:
  1115. @table @option
  1116. @item length
  1117. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1118. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 10]}.
  1119. @item metadata
  1120. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1121. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1122. disabled.
  1123. Available keys for each channel are:
  1124. DC_offset
  1125. Min_level
  1126. Max_level
  1127. Min_difference
  1128. Max_difference
  1129. Mean_difference
  1130. Peak_level
  1131. RMS_peak
  1132. RMS_trough
  1133. Crest_factor
  1134. Flat_factor
  1135. Peak_count
  1136. Bit_depth
  1137. and for Overall:
  1138. DC_offset
  1139. Min_level
  1140. Max_level
  1141. Min_difference
  1142. Max_difference
  1143. Mean_difference
  1144. Peak_level
  1145. RMS_level
  1146. RMS_peak
  1147. RMS_trough
  1148. Flat_factor
  1149. Peak_count
  1150. Bit_depth
  1151. Number_of_samples
  1152. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1153. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1154. For description what each key means read below.
  1155. @item reset
  1156. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1157. Default is disabled.
  1158. @end table
  1159. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1160. @table @option
  1161. @item DC offset
  1162. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1163. @item Min level
  1164. Minimal sample level.
  1165. @item Max level
  1166. Maximal sample level.
  1167. @item Min difference
  1168. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1169. @item Max difference
  1170. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1171. @item Mean difference
  1172. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1173. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1174. @item Peak level dB
  1175. @item RMS level dB
  1176. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1177. @item RMS peak dB
  1178. @item RMS trough dB
  1179. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1180. @item Crest factor
  1181. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1182. @item Flat factor
  1183. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1184. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1185. @item Peak count
  1186. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1187. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1188. @item Bit depth
  1189. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1190. @end table
  1191. @section asyncts
  1192. Synchronize audio data with timestamps by squeezing/stretching it and/or
  1193. dropping samples/adding silence when needed.
  1194. This filter is not built by default, please use @ref{aresample} to do squeezing/stretching.
  1195. It accepts the following parameters:
  1196. @table @option
  1197. @item compensate
  1198. Enable stretching/squeezing the data to make it match the timestamps. Disabled
  1199. by default. When disabled, time gaps are covered with silence.
  1200. @item min_delta
  1201. The minimum difference between timestamps and audio data (in seconds) to trigger
  1202. adding/dropping samples. The default value is 0.1. If you get an imperfect
  1203. sync with this filter, try setting this parameter to 0.
  1204. @item max_comp
  1205. The maximum compensation in samples per second. Only relevant with compensate=1.
  1206. The default value is 500.
  1207. @item first_pts
  1208. Assume that the first PTS should be this value. The time base is 1 / sample
  1209. rate. This allows for padding/trimming at the start of the stream. By default,
  1210. no assumption is made about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or
  1211. trimming is done. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with
  1212. silence if an audio stream starts after the video stream or to trim any samples
  1213. with a negative PTS due to encoder delay.
  1214. @end table
  1215. @section atempo
  1216. Adjust audio tempo.
  1217. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1218. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1219. be in the [0.5, 2.0] range.
  1220. @subsection Examples
  1221. @itemize
  1222. @item
  1223. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1224. @example
  1225. atempo=0.8
  1226. @end example
  1227. @item
  1228. To speed up audio to 125% tempo:
  1229. @example
  1230. atempo=1.25
  1231. @end example
  1232. @end itemize
  1233. @section atrim
  1234. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1235. It accepts the following parameters:
  1236. @table @option
  1237. @item start
  1238. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1239. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1240. @item end
  1241. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1242. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1243. the last sample in the output.
  1244. @item start_pts
  1245. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1246. instead of seconds.
  1247. @item end_pts
  1248. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1249. of seconds.
  1250. @item duration
  1251. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1252. @item start_sample
  1253. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1254. @item end_sample
  1255. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1256. @end table
  1257. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1258. duration specifications; see
  1259. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1260. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1261. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1262. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1263. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1264. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1265. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1266. atrim filter.
  1267. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1268. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1269. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1270. filters.
  1271. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1272. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1273. Examples:
  1274. @itemize
  1275. @item
  1276. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1277. @example
  1278. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1279. @end example
  1280. @item
  1281. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1282. @example
  1283. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1284. @end example
  1285. @end itemize
  1286. @section bandpass
  1287. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1288. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1289. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1290. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1291. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1292. The filter accepts the following options:
  1293. @table @option
  1294. @item frequency, f
  1295. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1296. @item csg
  1297. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1298. @item width_type
  1299. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1300. @table @option
  1301. @item h
  1302. Hz
  1303. @item q
  1304. Q-Factor
  1305. @item o
  1306. octave
  1307. @item s
  1308. slope
  1309. @end table
  1310. @item width, w
  1311. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1312. @end table
  1313. @section bandreject
  1314. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  1315. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  1316. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1317. The filter accepts the following options:
  1318. @table @option
  1319. @item frequency, f
  1320. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1321. @item width_type
  1322. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1323. @table @option
  1324. @item h
  1325. Hz
  1326. @item q
  1327. Q-Factor
  1328. @item o
  1329. octave
  1330. @item s
  1331. slope
  1332. @end table
  1333. @item width, w
  1334. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1335. @end table
  1336. @section bass
  1337. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  1338. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  1339. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  1340. The filter accepts the following options:
  1341. @table @option
  1342. @item gain, g
  1343. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  1344. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  1345. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  1346. @item frequency, f
  1347. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  1348. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  1349. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  1350. @item width_type
  1351. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1352. @table @option
  1353. @item h
  1354. Hz
  1355. @item q
  1356. Q-Factor
  1357. @item o
  1358. octave
  1359. @item s
  1360. slope
  1361. @end table
  1362. @item width, w
  1363. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  1364. @end table
  1365. @section biquad
  1366. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  1367. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  1368. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  1369. @section bs2b
  1370. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  1371. stereo audio records.
  1372. It accepts the following parameters:
  1373. @table @option
  1374. @item profile
  1375. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  1376. @table @option
  1377. @item default
  1378. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  1379. @item cmoy
  1380. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  1381. @item jmeier
  1382. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  1383. @end table
  1384. @item fcut
  1385. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  1386. @item feed
  1387. Feed level (in Hz).
  1388. @end table
  1389. @section channelmap
  1390. Remap input channels to new locations.
  1391. It accepts the following parameters:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item channel_layout
  1394. The channel layout of the output stream.
  1395. @item map
  1396. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  1397. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  1398. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  1399. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  1400. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  1401. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  1402. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  1403. @end table
  1404. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  1405. output channels, preserving indices.
  1406. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  1407. @example
  1408. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  1409. @end example
  1410. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  1411. the input.
  1412. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  1413. @example
  1414. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  1415. @end example
  1416. @section channelsplit
  1417. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  1418. It accepts the following parameters:
  1419. @table @option
  1420. @item channel_layout
  1421. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  1422. @end table
  1423. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  1424. @example
  1425. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  1426. @end example
  1427. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  1428. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  1429. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  1430. @example
  1431. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  1432. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  1433. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  1434. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  1435. side_right.wav
  1436. @end example
  1437. @section chorus
  1438. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  1439. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  1440. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  1441. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  1442. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  1443. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  1444. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  1445. off key.
  1446. It accepts the following parameters:
  1447. @table @option
  1448. @item in_gain
  1449. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1450. @item out_gain
  1451. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  1452. @item delays
  1453. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  1454. @item decays
  1455. Set decays.
  1456. @item speeds
  1457. Set speeds.
  1458. @item depths
  1459. Set depths.
  1460. @end table
  1461. @subsection Examples
  1462. @itemize
  1463. @item
  1464. A single delay:
  1465. @example
  1466. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  1467. @end example
  1468. @item
  1469. Two delays:
  1470. @example
  1471. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  1472. @end example
  1473. @item
  1474. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  1475. @example
  1476. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  1477. @end example
  1478. @end itemize
  1479. @section compand
  1480. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  1481. It accepts the following parameters:
  1482. @table @option
  1483. @item attacks
  1484. @item decays
  1485. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  1486. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  1487. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  1488. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  1489. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  1490. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  1491. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  1492. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  1493. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  1494. @item points
  1495. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  1496. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  1497. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  1498. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  1499. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  1500. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  1501. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  1502. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20}.
  1503. @item soft-knee
  1504. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  1505. @item gain
  1506. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  1507. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  1508. It defaults to 0.
  1509. @item volume
  1510. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  1511. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  1512. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  1513. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  1514. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  1515. @item delay
  1516. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  1517. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  1518. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  1519. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  1520. @end table
  1521. @subsection Examples
  1522. @itemize
  1523. @item
  1524. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  1525. noisy environment:
  1526. @example
  1527. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  1528. @end example
  1529. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  1530. @example
  1531. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  1532. @end example
  1533. @item
  1534. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  1535. @example
  1536. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  1537. @end example
  1538. @item
  1539. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  1540. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  1541. @example
  1542. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  1543. @end example
  1544. @item
  1545. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  1546. @example
  1547. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  1548. @end example
  1549. @item
  1550. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  1551. @example
  1552. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  1553. @end example
  1554. @item
  1555. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  1556. @example
  1557. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  1558. @end example
  1559. @item
  1560. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  1561. @example
  1562. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  1563. @end example
  1564. @item
  1565. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  1566. @example
  1567. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  1568. @end example
  1569. @item
  1570. Compressor/Gate:
  1571. @example
  1572. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  1573. @end example
  1574. @item
  1575. Expander:
  1576. @example
  1577. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  1578. @end example
  1579. @item
  1580. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  1581. @example
  1582. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  1583. @end example
  1584. @item
  1585. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  1586. @example
  1587. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  1588. @end example
  1589. @item
  1590. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  1591. @example
  1592. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  1593. @end example
  1594. @item
  1595. Soft limiter:
  1596. @example
  1597. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  1598. @end example
  1599. @end itemize
  1600. @section compensationdelay
  1601. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  1602. positions of microphones or speakers.
  1603. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  1604. different location. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  1605. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  1606. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  1607. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that distance of
  1608. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone to capture signal in
  1609. antiphase to another microphone. That makes the final mix sounding moody.
  1610. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  1611. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  1612. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  1613. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  1614. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  1615. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  1616. It accepts the following parameters:
  1617. @table @option
  1618. @item mm
  1619. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  1620. Default is 0.
  1621. @item cm
  1622. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  1623. Default is 0.
  1624. @item m
  1625. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  1626. Default is 0.
  1627. @item dry
  1628. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  1629. Default is 0.
  1630. @item wet
  1631. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  1632. Default is 1.
  1633. @item temp
  1634. Set temperature degree in Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  1635. Default is 20.
  1636. @end table
  1637. @section dcshift
  1638. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  1639. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  1640. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  1641. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  1642. a signal has a DC offset.
  1643. @table @option
  1644. @item shift
  1645. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  1646. the audio.
  1647. @item limitergain
  1648. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  1649. used to prevent clipping.
  1650. @end table
  1651. @section dynaudnorm
  1652. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  1653. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  1654. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  1655. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  1656. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  1657. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  1658. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  1659. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  1660. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  1661. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  1662. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  1663. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  1664. @table @option
  1665. @item f
  1666. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  1667. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  1668. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  1669. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  1670. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  1671. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  1672. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  1673. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  1674. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  1675. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  1676. been found to give good results with most files.
  1677. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  1678. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  1679. @item g
  1680. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  1681. number. Default is 31.
  1682. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  1683. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  1684. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  1685. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  1686. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  1687. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  1688. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  1689. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  1690. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  1691. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  1692. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  1693. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  1694. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  1695. @item p
  1696. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  1697. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  1698. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  1699. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  1700. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  1701. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  1702. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  1703. @item m
  1704. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  1705. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  1706. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  1707. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  1708. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  1709. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  1710. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  1711. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  1712. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  1713. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  1714. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  1715. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  1716. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  1717. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  1718. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  1719. value.
  1720. @item r
  1721. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  1722. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  1723. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  1724. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  1725. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  1726. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  1727. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  1728. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  1729. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  1730. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  1731. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  1732. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  1733. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  1734. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  1735. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  1736. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  1737. @item n
  1738. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  1739. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  1740. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  1741. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  1742. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  1743. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  1744. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  1745. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  1746. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  1747. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  1748. @item c
  1749. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  1750. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  1751. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  1752. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  1753. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  1754. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  1755. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  1756. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  1757. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  1758. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  1759. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  1760. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  1761. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  1762. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  1763. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  1764. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  1765. between neighbouring frames.
  1766. @item b
  1767. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  1768. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  1769. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  1770. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  1771. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  1772. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  1773. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  1774. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  1775. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  1776. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  1777. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  1778. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  1779. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  1780. @item s
  1781. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  1782. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  1783. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  1784. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  1785. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  1786. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  1787. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  1788. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  1789. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  1790. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  1791. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  1792. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  1793. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  1794. frame.
  1795. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  1796. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  1797. @end table
  1798. @section earwax
  1799. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  1800. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  1801. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  1802. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  1803. the listener (standard for speakers).
  1804. Ported from SoX.
  1805. @section equalizer
  1806. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  1807. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  1808. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  1809. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  1810. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  1811. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  1812. The filter accepts the following options:
  1813. @table @option
  1814. @item frequency, f
  1815. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  1816. @item width_type
  1817. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1818. @table @option
  1819. @item h
  1820. Hz
  1821. @item q
  1822. Q-Factor
  1823. @item o
  1824. octave
  1825. @item s
  1826. slope
  1827. @end table
  1828. @item width, w
  1829. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1830. @item gain, g
  1831. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  1832. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  1833. @end table
  1834. @subsection Examples
  1835. @itemize
  1836. @item
  1837. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  1838. @example
  1839. equalizer=f=1000:width_type=h:width=200:g=-10
  1840. @end example
  1841. @item
  1842. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  1843. @example
  1844. equalizer=f=1000:width_type=q:width=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:width_type=q:width=2:g=-5
  1845. @end example
  1846. @end itemize
  1847. @section extrastereo
  1848. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  1849. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  1850. The filter accepts the following option:
  1851. @table @option
  1852. @item m
  1853. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  1854. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  1855. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  1856. @item c
  1857. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  1858. @end table
  1859. @section firequalizer
  1860. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  1861. The filter accepts the following option:
  1862. @table @option
  1863. @item gain
  1864. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  1865. @table @option
  1866. @item f
  1867. the evaluated frequency
  1868. @item sr
  1869. sample rate
  1870. @item ch
  1871. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  1872. @item chid
  1873. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  1874. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  1875. @item chs
  1876. number of channels
  1877. @item chlayout
  1878. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  1879. @end table
  1880. and functions:
  1881. @table @option
  1882. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  1883. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  1884. @end table
  1885. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  1886. @item gain_entry
  1887. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  1888. contain functions:
  1889. @table @option
  1890. @item entry(f, g)
  1891. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  1892. @end table
  1893. This option is also available as command.
  1894. @item delay
  1895. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  1896. Default is @code{0.01}.
  1897. @item accuracy
  1898. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  1899. Default is @code{5}.
  1900. @item wfunc
  1901. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  1902. @table @option
  1903. @item rectangular
  1904. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  1905. @item hann
  1906. hann window (default)
  1907. @item hamming
  1908. hamming window
  1909. @item blackman
  1910. blackman window
  1911. @item nuttall3
  1912. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  1913. @item mnuttall3
  1914. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  1915. @item nuttall
  1916. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  1917. @item bnuttall
  1918. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  1919. @item bharris
  1920. blackman-harris window
  1921. @end table
  1922. @item fixed
  1923. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  1924. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  1925. @item multi
  1926. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  1927. @end table
  1928. @subsection Examples
  1929. @itemize
  1930. @item
  1931. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  1932. @example
  1933. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  1934. @end example
  1935. @item
  1936. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  1937. @example
  1938. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  1939. @end example
  1940. @item
  1941. custom equalization:
  1942. @example
  1943. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  1944. @end example
  1945. @item
  1946. higher delay:
  1947. @example
  1948. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on
  1949. @end example
  1950. @item
  1951. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  1952. @example
  1953. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  1954. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  1955. @end example
  1956. @end itemize
  1957. @section flanger
  1958. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  1959. The filter accepts the following options:
  1960. @table @option
  1961. @item delay
  1962. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  1963. @item depth
  1964. Set added swep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  1965. @item regen
  1966. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  1967. Default value is 0.
  1968. @item width
  1969. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  1970. Default value is 71.
  1971. @item speed
  1972. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  1973. @item shape
  1974. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  1975. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  1976. @item phase
  1977. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  1978. Default value is 25.
  1979. @item interp
  1980. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  1981. Default is @var{linear}.
  1982. @end table
  1983. @section highpass
  1984. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  1985. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  1986. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  1987. The filter accepts the following options:
  1988. @table @option
  1989. @item frequency, f
  1990. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  1991. @item poles, p
  1992. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  1993. @item width_type
  1994. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1995. @table @option
  1996. @item h
  1997. Hz
  1998. @item q
  1999. Q-Factor
  2000. @item o
  2001. octave
  2002. @item s
  2003. slope
  2004. @end table
  2005. @item width, w
  2006. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2007. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  2008. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  2009. @end table
  2010. @section join
  2011. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  2012. It accepts the following parameters:
  2013. @table @option
  2014. @item inputs
  2015. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  2016. @item channel_layout
  2017. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  2018. @item map
  2019. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2020. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  2021. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  2022. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  2023. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  2024. channel.
  2025. @end table
  2026. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  2027. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  2028. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  2029. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  2030. @example
  2031. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  2032. @end example
  2033. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  2034. @example
  2035. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  2036. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  2037. out
  2038. @end example
  2039. @section ladspa
  2040. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  2041. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2042. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  2043. @table @option
  2044. @item file, f
  2045. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  2046. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  2047. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  2048. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  2049. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  2050. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  2051. @item plugin, p
  2052. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  2053. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  2054. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  2055. @item controls, c
  2056. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  2057. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  2058. threshold or gain).
  2059. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  2060. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  2061. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  2062. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  2063. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  2064. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  2065. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  2066. their valid ranges are printed.
  2067. @item sample_rate, s
  2068. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  2069. zero inputs.
  2070. @item nb_samples, n
  2071. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  2072. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  2073. @item duration, d
  2074. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  2075. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  2076. for the accepted syntax.
  2077. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  2078. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  2079. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  2080. supposed to be generated forever.
  2081. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  2082. @end table
  2083. @subsection Examples
  2084. @itemize
  2085. @item
  2086. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  2087. @example
  2088. ladspa=file=amp
  2089. @end example
  2090. @item
  2091. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  2092. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  2093. @example
  2094. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  2095. @end example
  2096. @item
  2097. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  2098. plugin library:
  2099. @example
  2100. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  2101. @end example
  2102. @item
  2103. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  2104. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  2105. @example
  2106. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  2107. @end example
  2108. @item
  2109. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  2110. @example
  2111. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  2112. @end example
  2113. @item
  2114. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  2115. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  2116. @example
  2117. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  2118. @end example
  2119. @item
  2120. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  2121. @example
  2122. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  2123. @end example
  2124. @item
  2125. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  2126. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  2127. @example
  2128. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  2129. @end example
  2130. @item
  2131. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  2132. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  2133. @example
  2134. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  2135. @end example
  2136. @end itemize
  2137. @subsection Commands
  2138. This filter supports the following commands:
  2139. @table @option
  2140. @item cN
  2141. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  2142. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  2143. @end table
  2144. @section lowpass
  2145. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  2146. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  2147. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  2148. The filter accepts the following options:
  2149. @table @option
  2150. @item frequency, f
  2151. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  2152. @item poles, p
  2153. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  2154. @item width_type
  2155. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2156. @table @option
  2157. @item h
  2158. Hz
  2159. @item q
  2160. Q-Factor
  2161. @item o
  2162. octave
  2163. @item s
  2164. slope
  2165. @end table
  2166. @item width, w
  2167. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2168. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  2169. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  2170. @end table
  2171. @anchor{pan}
  2172. @section pan
  2173. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  2174. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  2175. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  2176. stream.
  2177. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  2178. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  2179. @table @option
  2180. @item l
  2181. output channel layout or number of channels
  2182. @item outdef
  2183. output channel specification, of the form:
  2184. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[+[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  2185. @item out_name
  2186. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  2187. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  2188. @item gain
  2189. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  2190. @item in_name
  2191. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  2192. named and numbered input channels
  2193. @end table
  2194. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  2195. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  2196. avoiding clipping noise.
  2197. @subsection Mixing examples
  2198. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  2199. factor for the left channel:
  2200. @example
  2201. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  2202. @end example
  2203. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  2204. 7-channels surround:
  2205. @example
  2206. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  2207. @end example
  2208. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  2209. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  2210. needs.
  2211. @subsection Remapping examples
  2212. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  2213. @itemize
  2214. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  2215. @item only one input per channel output,
  2216. @end itemize
  2217. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  2218. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  2219. remapping.
  2220. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  2221. dropping the extra channels:
  2222. @example
  2223. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  2224. @end example
  2225. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  2226. and keep the input channel layout:
  2227. @example
  2228. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  2229. @end example
  2230. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  2231. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  2232. @example
  2233. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  2234. @end example
  2235. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  2236. front left and right:
  2237. @example
  2238. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  2239. @end example
  2240. @section replaygain
  2241. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  2242. outputs it unchanged.
  2243. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  2244. @section resample
  2245. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  2246. not meant to be used directly.
  2247. @section rubberband
  2248. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  2249. The filter accepts the following options:
  2250. @table @option
  2251. @item tempo
  2252. Set tempo scale factor.
  2253. @item pitch
  2254. Set pitch scale factor.
  2255. @item transients
  2256. Set transients detector.
  2257. Possible values are:
  2258. @table @var
  2259. @item crisp
  2260. @item mixed
  2261. @item smooth
  2262. @end table
  2263. @item detector
  2264. Set detector.
  2265. Possible values are:
  2266. @table @var
  2267. @item compound
  2268. @item percussive
  2269. @item soft
  2270. @end table
  2271. @item phase
  2272. Set phase.
  2273. Possible values are:
  2274. @table @var
  2275. @item laminar
  2276. @item independent
  2277. @end table
  2278. @item window
  2279. Set processing window size.
  2280. Possible values are:
  2281. @table @var
  2282. @item standard
  2283. @item short
  2284. @item long
  2285. @end table
  2286. @item smoothing
  2287. Set smoothing.
  2288. Possible values are:
  2289. @table @var
  2290. @item off
  2291. @item on
  2292. @end table
  2293. @item formant
  2294. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  2295. Possible values are:
  2296. @table @var
  2297. @item shifted
  2298. @item preserved
  2299. @end table
  2300. @item pitchq
  2301. Set pitch quality.
  2302. Possible values are:
  2303. @table @var
  2304. @item quality
  2305. @item speed
  2306. @item consistency
  2307. @end table
  2308. @item channels
  2309. Set channels.
  2310. Possible values are:
  2311. @table @var
  2312. @item apart
  2313. @item together
  2314. @end table
  2315. @end table
  2316. @section sidechaincompress
  2317. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  2318. detected signal using second input signal.
  2319. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  2320. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  2321. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  2322. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  2323. The filter accepts the following options:
  2324. @table @option
  2325. @item level_in
  2326. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  2327. @item threshold
  2328. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  2329. reduction of first stream.
  2330. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  2331. @item ratio
  2332. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  2333. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  2334. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  2335. @item attack
  2336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  2337. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  2338. @item release
  2339. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  2340. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  2341. @item makeup
  2342. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  2343. Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
  2344. @item knee
  2345. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  2346. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  2347. @item link
  2348. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  2349. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  2350. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  2351. @item detection
  2352. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  2353. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  2354. @item level_sc
  2355. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  2356. @item mix
  2357. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  2358. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2359. @end table
  2360. @subsection Examples
  2361. @itemize
  2362. @item
  2363. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  2364. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  2365. merged with 2nd input:
  2366. @example
  2367. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  2368. @end example
  2369. @end itemize
  2370. @section sidechaingate
  2371. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  2372. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  2373. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  2374. threshold.
  2375. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  2376. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  2377. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  2378. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  2379. guitar.
  2380. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  2381. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  2382. The filter accepts the following options:
  2383. @table @option
  2384. @item level_in
  2385. Set input level before filtering.
  2386. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2387. @item range
  2388. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  2389. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2390. @item threshold
  2391. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  2392. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2393. @item ratio
  2394. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  2395. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  2396. @item attack
  2397. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  2398. reduction stops.
  2399. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  2400. @item release
  2401. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  2402. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  2403. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  2404. @item makeup
  2405. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  2406. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  2407. @item knee
  2408. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  2409. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  2410. @item detection
  2411. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  2412. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  2413. @item link
  2414. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  2415. the reduction.
  2416. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  2417. @item level_sc
  2418. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2419. @end table
  2420. @section silencedetect
  2421. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  2422. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  2423. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  2424. minimum detected noise duration.
  2425. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds.
  2426. The filter accepts the following options:
  2427. @table @option
  2428. @item duration, d
  2429. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  2430. @item noise, n
  2431. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  2432. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  2433. @end table
  2434. @subsection Examples
  2435. @itemize
  2436. @item
  2437. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  2438. @example
  2439. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  2440. @end example
  2441. @item
  2442. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  2443. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  2444. @example
  2445. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  2446. @end example
  2447. @end itemize
  2448. @section silenceremove
  2449. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  2450. The filter accepts the following options:
  2451. @table @option
  2452. @item start_periods
  2453. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  2454. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  2455. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  2456. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  2457. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  2458. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  2459. Default value is @code{0}.
  2460. @item start_duration
  2461. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  2462. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  2463. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  2464. @item start_threshold
  2465. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  2466. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  2467. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  2468. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  2469. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  2470. @item stop_periods
  2471. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  2472. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  2473. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  2474. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  2475. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  2476. in the middle of the audio.
  2477. Default value is @code{0}.
  2478. @item stop_duration
  2479. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  2480. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  2481. the audio.
  2482. Default value is @code{0}.
  2483. @item stop_threshold
  2484. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  2485. the end of audio.
  2486. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  2487. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  2488. @item leave_silence
  2489. This indicate that @var{stop_duration} length of audio should be left intact
  2490. at the beginning of each period of silence.
  2491. For example, if you want to remove long pauses between words but do not want
  2492. to remove the pauses completely. Default value is @code{0}.
  2493. @item detection
  2494. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  2495. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  2496. Default value is @code{rms}.
  2497. @item window
  2498. Set ratio used to calculate size of window for detecting silence.
  2499. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  2500. @end table
  2501. @subsection Examples
  2502. @itemize
  2503. @item
  2504. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  2505. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  2506. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  2507. @example
  2508. silenceremove=1:5:0.02
  2509. @end example
  2510. @item
  2511. Trim all silence encountered from begining to end where there is more than 1
  2512. second of silence in audio:
  2513. @example
  2514. silenceremove=0:0:0:-1:1:-90dB
  2515. @end example
  2516. @end itemize
  2517. @section sofalizer
  2518. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  2519. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  2520. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  2521. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  2522. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  2523. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  2524. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2525. @code{--enable-netcdf}.
  2526. The filter accepts the following options:
  2527. @table @option
  2528. @item sofa
  2529. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  2530. @item gain
  2531. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2532. @item rotation
  2533. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  2534. @item elevation
  2535. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  2536. @item radius
  2537. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  2538. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  2539. @item type
  2540. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  2541. processing audio in time domain which is slow but gives high quality output.
  2542. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast but gives
  2543. mediocre output. Default is @var{freq}.
  2544. @end table
  2545. @section stereotools
  2546. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  2547. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  2548. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  2549. The filter accepts the following options:
  2550. @table @option
  2551. @item level_in
  2552. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  2553. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2554. @item level_out
  2555. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  2556. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2557. @item balance_in
  2558. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  2559. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2560. @item balance_out
  2561. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  2562. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2563. @item softclip
  2564. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  2565. clipping. Disabled by default.
  2566. @item mutel
  2567. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  2568. @item muter
  2569. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  2570. @item phasel
  2571. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  2572. @item phaser
  2573. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  2574. @item mode
  2575. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  2576. @table @samp
  2577. @item lr>lr
  2578. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  2579. @item lr>ms
  2580. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  2581. @item ms>lr
  2582. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  2583. @item lr>ll
  2584. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  2585. @item lr>rr
  2586. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  2587. @item lr>l+r
  2588. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  2589. @item lr>rl
  2590. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  2591. @end table
  2592. @item slev
  2593. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  2594. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2595. @item sbal
  2596. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  2597. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2598. @item mlev
  2599. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  2600. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2601. @item mpan
  2602. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2603. @item base
  2604. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  2605. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2606. @item delay
  2607. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  2608. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  2609. @item sclevel
  2610. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  2611. @item phase
  2612. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  2613. @end table
  2614. @section stereowiden
  2615. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  2616. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  2617. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  2618. The filter accepts the following options:
  2619. @table @option
  2620. @item delay
  2621. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  2622. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  2623. @item feedback
  2624. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  2625. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  2626. effect. Default is 0.3.
  2627. @item crossfeed
  2628. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  2629. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  2630. channels. Default is 0.3.
  2631. @item drymix
  2632. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  2633. @end table
  2634. @section treble
  2635. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2636. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2637. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2638. The filter accepts the following options:
  2639. @table @option
  2640. @item gain, g
  2641. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  2642. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  2643. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2644. @item frequency, f
  2645. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2646. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2647. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  2648. @item width_type
  2649. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2650. @table @option
  2651. @item h
  2652. Hz
  2653. @item q
  2654. Q-Factor
  2655. @item o
  2656. octave
  2657. @item s
  2658. slope
  2659. @end table
  2660. @item width, w
  2661. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2662. @end table
  2663. @section tremolo
  2664. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  2665. The filter accepts the following options:
  2666. @table @option
  2667. @item f
  2668. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  2669. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  2670. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  2671. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  2672. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  2673. @item d
  2674. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  2675. Default value is 0.5.
  2676. @end table
  2677. @section vibrato
  2678. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  2679. The filter accepts the following options:
  2680. @table @option
  2681. @item f
  2682. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  2683. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  2684. @item d
  2685. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  2686. Default value is 0.5.
  2687. @end table
  2688. @section volume
  2689. Adjust the input audio volume.
  2690. It accepts the following parameters:
  2691. @table @option
  2692. @item volume
  2693. Set audio volume expression.
  2694. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  2695. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  2696. @example
  2697. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  2698. @end example
  2699. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  2700. @item precision
  2701. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  2702. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  2703. precision of the volume scaling.
  2704. @table @option
  2705. @item fixed
  2706. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  2707. @item float
  2708. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  2709. @item double
  2710. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  2711. @end table
  2712. @item replaygain
  2713. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  2714. @table @option
  2715. @item drop
  2716. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  2717. @item ignore
  2718. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  2719. @item track
  2720. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  2721. @item album
  2722. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  2723. @end table
  2724. @item replaygain_preamp
  2725. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  2726. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  2727. @item eval
  2728. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  2729. It accepts the following values:
  2730. @table @samp
  2731. @item once
  2732. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  2733. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  2734. @item frame
  2735. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  2736. @end table
  2737. Default value is @samp{once}.
  2738. @end table
  2739. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  2740. @table @option
  2741. @item n
  2742. frame number (starting at zero)
  2743. @item nb_channels
  2744. number of channels
  2745. @item nb_consumed_samples
  2746. number of samples consumed by the filter
  2747. @item nb_samples
  2748. number of samples in the current frame
  2749. @item pos
  2750. original frame position in the file
  2751. @item pts
  2752. frame PTS
  2753. @item sample_rate
  2754. sample rate
  2755. @item startpts
  2756. PTS at start of stream
  2757. @item startt
  2758. time at start of stream
  2759. @item t
  2760. frame time
  2761. @item tb
  2762. timestamp timebase
  2763. @item volume
  2764. last set volume value
  2765. @end table
  2766. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  2767. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  2768. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  2769. @subsection Commands
  2770. This filter supports the following commands:
  2771. @table @option
  2772. @item volume
  2773. Modify the volume expression.
  2774. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  2775. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  2776. value.
  2777. @item replaygain_noclip
  2778. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  2779. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  2780. @end table
  2781. @subsection Examples
  2782. @itemize
  2783. @item
  2784. Halve the input audio volume:
  2785. @example
  2786. volume=volume=0.5
  2787. volume=volume=1/2
  2788. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  2789. @end example
  2790. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  2791. omitted, for example like in:
  2792. @example
  2793. volume=0.5
  2794. @end example
  2795. @item
  2796. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  2797. @example
  2798. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  2799. @end example
  2800. @item
  2801. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  2802. @example
  2803. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  2804. @end example
  2805. @end itemize
  2806. @section volumedetect
  2807. Detect the volume of the input video.
  2808. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  2809. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  2810. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  2811. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  2812. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  2813. the samples).
  2814. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  2815. @subsection Examples
  2816. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  2817. @example
  2818. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  2819. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  2820. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  2821. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  2822. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  2823. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  2824. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  2825. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  2826. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  2827. @end example
  2828. It means that:
  2829. @itemize
  2830. @item
  2831. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  2832. @item
  2833. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  2834. @item
  2835. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  2836. @end itemize
  2837. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  2838. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  2839. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  2840. @chapter Audio Sources
  2841. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  2842. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  2843. @section abuffer
  2844. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  2845. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  2846. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  2847. It accepts the following parameters:
  2848. @table @option
  2849. @item time_base
  2850. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  2851. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  2852. @item sample_rate
  2853. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  2854. @item sample_fmt
  2855. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  2856. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  2857. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  2858. @item channel_layout
  2859. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  2860. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  2861. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  2862. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  2863. @item channels
  2864. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  2865. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  2866. must be consistent.
  2867. @end table
  2868. @subsection Examples
  2869. @example
  2870. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  2871. @end example
  2872. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  2873. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  2874. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  2875. equivalent to:
  2876. @example
  2877. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  2878. @end example
  2879. @section aevalsrc
  2880. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  2881. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  2882. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  2883. audio signal.
  2884. This source accepts the following options:
  2885. @table @option
  2886. @item exprs
  2887. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  2888. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  2889. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  2890. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  2891. @item channel_layout, c
  2892. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  2893. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  2894. @item duration, d
  2895. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  2896. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  2897. for the accepted syntax.
  2898. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  2899. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  2900. complete frame.
  2901. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  2902. supposed to be generated forever.
  2903. @item nb_samples, n
  2904. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  2905. default to 1024.
  2906. @item sample_rate, s
  2907. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  2908. @end table
  2909. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  2910. @table @option
  2911. @item n
  2912. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  2913. @item t
  2914. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  2915. @item s
  2916. sample rate
  2917. @end table
  2918. @subsection Examples
  2919. @itemize
  2920. @item
  2921. Generate silence:
  2922. @example
  2923. aevalsrc=0
  2924. @end example
  2925. @item
  2926. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  2927. 8000 Hz:
  2928. @example
  2929. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  2930. @end example
  2931. @item
  2932. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  2933. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  2934. @example
  2935. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  2936. @end example
  2937. @item
  2938. Generate white noise:
  2939. @example
  2940. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  2941. @end example
  2942. @item
  2943. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  2944. @example
  2945. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  2946. @end example
  2947. @item
  2948. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  2949. @example
  2950. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  2951. @end example
  2952. @end itemize
  2953. @section anullsrc
  2954. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  2955. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  2956. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  2957. synth filter).
  2958. This source accepts the following options:
  2959. @table @option
  2960. @item channel_layout, cl
  2961. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  2962. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  2963. is "stereo".
  2964. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  2965. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  2966. channel layout values.
  2967. @item sample_rate, r
  2968. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  2969. @item nb_samples, n
  2970. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  2971. @end table
  2972. @subsection Examples
  2973. @itemize
  2974. @item
  2975. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  2976. @example
  2977. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  2978. @end example
  2979. @item
  2980. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  2981. @example
  2982. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  2983. @end example
  2984. @end itemize
  2985. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  2986. @section flite
  2987. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  2988. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2989. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  2990. Note that the flite library is not thread-safe.
  2991. The filter accepts the following options:
  2992. @table @option
  2993. @item list_voices
  2994. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  2995. immediately. Default value is 0.
  2996. @item nb_samples, n
  2997. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  2998. @item textfile
  2999. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  3000. @item text
  3001. Set the text to speak.
  3002. @item voice, v
  3003. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  3004. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  3005. @end table
  3006. @subsection Examples
  3007. @itemize
  3008. @item
  3009. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  3010. standard flite voice:
  3011. @example
  3012. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  3013. @end example
  3014. @item
  3015. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  3016. @example
  3017. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  3018. @end example
  3019. @item
  3020. Input text to ffmpeg:
  3021. @example
  3022. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  3023. @end example
  3024. @item
  3025. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  3026. the @code{lavfi} device:
  3027. @example
  3028. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  3029. @end example
  3030. @end itemize
  3031. For more information about libflite, check:
  3032. @url{http://www.speech.cs.cmu.edu/flite/}
  3033. @section anoisesrc
  3034. Generate a noise audio signal.
  3035. The filter accepts the following options:
  3036. @table @option
  3037. @item sample_rate, r
  3038. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  3039. @item amplitude, a
  3040. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  3041. is 1.0.
  3042. @item duration, d
  3043. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  3044. results in noise with an infinite length.
  3045. @item color, colour, c
  3046. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, and brown.
  3047. Default color is white.
  3048. @item seed, s
  3049. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  3050. @item nb_samples, n
  3051. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  3052. @end table
  3053. @subsection Examples
  3054. @itemize
  3055. @item
  3056. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  3057. @example
  3058. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  3059. @end example
  3060. @end itemize
  3061. @section sine
  3062. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  3063. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  3064. The filter accepts the following options:
  3065. @table @option
  3066. @item frequency, f
  3067. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  3068. @item beep_factor, b
  3069. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  3070. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  3071. @item sample_rate, r
  3072. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  3073. @item duration, d
  3074. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  3075. @item samples_per_frame
  3076. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  3077. The expression can contain the following constants:
  3078. @table @option
  3079. @item n
  3080. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  3081. @item pts
  3082. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  3083. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  3084. @item t
  3085. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  3086. @item TB
  3087. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  3088. @end table
  3089. Default is @code{1024}.
  3090. @end table
  3091. @subsection Examples
  3092. @itemize
  3093. @item
  3094. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  3095. @example
  3096. sine
  3097. @end example
  3098. @item
  3099. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  3100. @example
  3101. sine=220:4:d=5
  3102. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  3103. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  3104. @end example
  3105. @item
  3106. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  3107. pattern:
  3108. @example
  3109. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  3110. @end example
  3111. @end itemize
  3112. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  3113. @chapter Audio Sinks
  3114. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  3115. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  3116. @section abuffersink
  3117. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  3118. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  3119. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  3120. or the options system.
  3121. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  3122. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  3123. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  3124. @section anullsink
  3125. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  3126. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  3127. tools.
  3128. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  3129. @chapter Video Filters
  3130. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  3131. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  3132. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  3133. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  3134. build.
  3135. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  3136. @section alphaextract
  3137. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  3138. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  3139. @section alphamerge
  3140. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  3141. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  3142. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  3143. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  3144. channel.
  3145. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  3146. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  3147. @example
  3148. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  3149. @end example
  3150. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  3151. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  3152. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  3153. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  3154. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  3155. @section ass
  3156. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  3157. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  3158. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  3159. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  3160. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  3161. @table @option
  3162. @item shaping
  3163. Set the shaping engine
  3164. Available values are:
  3165. @table @samp
  3166. @item auto
  3167. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  3168. @item simple
  3169. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  3170. @item complex
  3171. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  3172. @end table
  3173. The default is @code{auto}.
  3174. @end table
  3175. @section atadenoise
  3176. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  3177. The filter accepts the following options:
  3178. @table @option
  3179. @item 0a
  3180. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  3181. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3182. @item 0b
  3183. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  3184. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3185. @item 1a
  3186. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  3187. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3188. @item 1b
  3189. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  3190. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3191. @item 2a
  3192. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  3193. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3194. @item 2b
  3195. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  3196. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3197. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  3198. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  3199. @item s
  3200. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 33. Must be odd
  3201. number in range [5, 129].
  3202. @end table
  3203. @section bbox
  3204. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  3205. luminance plane.
  3206. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  3207. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  3208. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  3209. log.
  3210. The filter accepts the following option:
  3211. @table @option
  3212. @item min_val
  3213. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  3214. @end table
  3215. @section blackdetect
  3216. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  3217. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  3218. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  3219. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  3220. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  3221. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  3222. The filter accepts the following options:
  3223. @table @option
  3224. @item black_min_duration, d
  3225. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  3226. be a non-negative floating point number.
  3227. Default value is 2.0.
  3228. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  3229. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  3230. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  3231. @example
  3232. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  3233. @end example
  3234. for which a picture is considered black.
  3235. Default value is 0.98.
  3236. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  3237. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  3238. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  3239. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  3240. the following equation:
  3241. @example
  3242. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  3243. @end example
  3244. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  3245. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  3246. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  3247. Default value is 0.10.
  3248. @end table
  3249. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  3250. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  3251. @example
  3252. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  3253. @end example
  3254. @section blackframe
  3255. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  3256. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  3257. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  3258. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  3259. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  3260. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  3261. It accepts the following parameters:
  3262. @table @option
  3263. @item amount
  3264. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  3265. @code{98}.
  3266. @item threshold, thresh
  3267. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  3268. @code{32}.
  3269. @end table
  3270. @section blend, tblend
  3271. Blend two video frames into each other.
  3272. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  3273. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  3274. "bottom" layer. Output terminates when shortest input terminates.
  3275. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  3276. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  3277. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  3278. A description of the accepted options follows.
  3279. @table @option
  3280. @item c0_mode
  3281. @item c1_mode
  3282. @item c2_mode
  3283. @item c3_mode
  3284. @item all_mode
  3285. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3286. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  3287. Available values for component modes are:
  3288. @table @samp
  3289. @item addition
  3290. @item addition128
  3291. @item and
  3292. @item average
  3293. @item burn
  3294. @item darken
  3295. @item difference
  3296. @item difference128
  3297. @item divide
  3298. @item dodge
  3299. @item freeze
  3300. @item exclusion
  3301. @item glow
  3302. @item hardlight
  3303. @item hardmix
  3304. @item heat
  3305. @item lighten
  3306. @item linearlight
  3307. @item multiply
  3308. @item multiply128
  3309. @item negation
  3310. @item normal
  3311. @item or
  3312. @item overlay
  3313. @item phoenix
  3314. @item pinlight
  3315. @item reflect
  3316. @item screen
  3317. @item softlight
  3318. @item subtract
  3319. @item vividlight
  3320. @item xor
  3321. @end table
  3322. @item c0_opacity
  3323. @item c1_opacity
  3324. @item c2_opacity
  3325. @item c3_opacity
  3326. @item all_opacity
  3327. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3328. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  3329. @item c0_expr
  3330. @item c1_expr
  3331. @item c2_expr
  3332. @item c3_expr
  3333. @item all_expr
  3334. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3335. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  3336. The expressions can use the following variables:
  3337. @table @option
  3338. @item N
  3339. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  3340. @item X
  3341. @item Y
  3342. the coordinates of the current sample
  3343. @item W
  3344. @item H
  3345. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  3346. @item SW
  3347. @item SH
  3348. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  3349. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  3350. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  3351. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  3352. @item T
  3353. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  3354. @item TOP, A
  3355. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  3356. @item BOTTOM, B
  3357. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  3358. @end table
  3359. @item shortest
  3360. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is
  3361. @code{0}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
  3362. @item repeatlast
  3363. Continue applying the last bottom frame after the end of the stream. A value of
  3364. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the bottom layer is reached.
  3365. Default is @code{1}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
  3366. @end table
  3367. @subsection Examples
  3368. @itemize
  3369. @item
  3370. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  3371. @example
  3372. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  3373. @end example
  3374. @item
  3375. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  3376. @example
  3377. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  3378. @end example
  3379. @item
  3380. Apply uncover left effect:
  3381. @example
  3382. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  3383. @end example
  3384. @item
  3385. Apply uncover down effect:
  3386. @example
  3387. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  3388. @end example
  3389. @item
  3390. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  3391. @example
  3392. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  3393. @end example
  3394. @item
  3395. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  3396. @example
  3397. blend=all_expr=if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)
  3398. @end example
  3399. @item
  3400. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  3401. @example
  3402. tblend=all_mode=difference128
  3403. @end example
  3404. @end itemize
  3405. @section bwdif
  3406. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  3407. Deinterlacing Filter").
  3408. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  3409. interpolation algorithms.
  3410. It accepts the following parameters:
  3411. @table @option
  3412. @item mode
  3413. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  3414. @table @option
  3415. @item 0, send_frame
  3416. Output one frame for each frame.
  3417. @item 1, send_field
  3418. Output one frame for each field.
  3419. @end table
  3420. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  3421. @item parity
  3422. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  3423. of the following values:
  3424. @table @option
  3425. @item 0, tff
  3426. Assume the top field is first.
  3427. @item 1, bff
  3428. Assume the bottom field is first.
  3429. @item -1, auto
  3430. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  3431. @end table
  3432. The default value is @code{auto}.
  3433. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  3434. top field first will be assumed.
  3435. @item deint
  3436. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
  3437. values:
  3438. @table @option
  3439. @item 0, all
  3440. Deinterlace all frames.
  3441. @item 1, interlaced
  3442. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  3443. @end table
  3444. The default value is @code{all}.
  3445. @end table
  3446. @section boxblur
  3447. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  3448. It accepts the following parameters:
  3449. @table @option
  3450. @item luma_radius, lr
  3451. @item luma_power, lp
  3452. @item chroma_radius, cr
  3453. @item chroma_power, cp
  3454. @item alpha_radius, ar
  3455. @item alpha_power, ap
  3456. @end table
  3457. A description of the accepted options follows.
  3458. @table @option
  3459. @item luma_radius, lr
  3460. @item chroma_radius, cr
  3461. @item alpha_radius, ar
  3462. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  3463. corresponding input plane.
  3464. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  3465. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  3466. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  3467. planes.
  3468. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  3469. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  3470. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  3471. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  3472. @table @option
  3473. @item w
  3474. @item h
  3475. The input width and height in pixels.
  3476. @item cw
  3477. @item ch
  3478. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  3479. @item hsub
  3480. @item vsub
  3481. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  3482. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  3483. @end table
  3484. @item luma_power, lp
  3485. @item chroma_power, cp
  3486. @item alpha_power, ap
  3487. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  3488. corresponding plane.
  3489. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  3490. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  3491. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  3492. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  3493. @end table
  3494. @subsection Examples
  3495. @itemize
  3496. @item
  3497. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  3498. set to 2:
  3499. @example
  3500. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  3501. boxblur=2:1
  3502. @end example
  3503. @item
  3504. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  3505. @example
  3506. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  3507. @end example
  3508. @item
  3509. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  3510. @example
  3511. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  3512. @end example
  3513. @end itemize
  3514. @section chromakey
  3515. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  3516. The filter accepts the following options:
  3517. @table @option
  3518. @item color
  3519. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  3520. @item similarity
  3521. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  3522. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  3523. @item blend
  3524. Blend percentage.
  3525. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  3526. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  3527. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  3528. @item yuv
  3529. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  3530. Litteral colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  3531. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  3532. @end table
  3533. @subsection Examples
  3534. @itemize
  3535. @item
  3536. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  3537. @example
  3538. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  3539. @end example
  3540. @item
  3541. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  3542. @example
  3543. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  3544. @end example
  3545. @end itemize
  3546. @section codecview
  3547. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  3548. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  3549. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  3550. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  3551. The filter accepts the following option:
  3552. @table @option
  3553. @item mv
  3554. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  3555. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  3556. @table @samp
  3557. @item pf
  3558. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  3559. @item bf
  3560. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  3561. @item bb
  3562. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  3563. @end table
  3564. @item qp
  3565. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes
  3566. @end table
  3567. @subsection Examples
  3568. @itemize
  3569. @item
  3570. Visualizes multi-directionals MVs from P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  3571. @example
  3572. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mpg -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  3573. @end example
  3574. @end itemize
  3575. @section colorbalance
  3576. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  3577. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  3578. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  3579. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  3580. value towards the complementary color.
  3581. The filter accepts the following options:
  3582. @table @option
  3583. @item rs
  3584. @item gs
  3585. @item bs
  3586. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  3587. @item rm
  3588. @item gm
  3589. @item bm
  3590. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  3591. @item rh
  3592. @item gh
  3593. @item bh
  3594. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  3595. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3596. @end table
  3597. @subsection Examples
  3598. @itemize
  3599. @item
  3600. Add red color cast to shadows:
  3601. @example
  3602. colorbalance=rs=.3
  3603. @end example
  3604. @end itemize
  3605. @section colorkey
  3606. RGB colorspace color keying.
  3607. The filter accepts the following options:
  3608. @table @option
  3609. @item color
  3610. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  3611. @item similarity
  3612. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  3613. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  3614. @item blend
  3615. Blend percentage.
  3616. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  3617. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  3618. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  3619. @end table
  3620. @subsection Examples
  3621. @itemize
  3622. @item
  3623. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  3624. @example
  3625. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  3626. @end example
  3627. @item
  3628. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  3629. @example
  3630. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  3631. @end example
  3632. @end itemize
  3633. @section colorlevels
  3634. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  3635. The filter accepts the following options:
  3636. @table @option
  3637. @item rimin
  3638. @item gimin
  3639. @item bimin
  3640. @item aimin
  3641. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  3642. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3643. @item rimax
  3644. @item gimax
  3645. @item bimax
  3646. @item aimax
  3647. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  3648. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  3649. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  3650. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  3651. @item romin
  3652. @item gomin
  3653. @item bomin
  3654. @item aomin
  3655. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  3656. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3657. @item romax
  3658. @item gomax
  3659. @item bomax
  3660. @item aomax
  3661. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  3662. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  3663. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  3664. @end table
  3665. @subsection Examples
  3666. @itemize
  3667. @item
  3668. Make video output darker:
  3669. @example
  3670. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  3671. @end example
  3672. @item
  3673. Increase contrast:
  3674. @example
  3675. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  3676. @end example
  3677. @item
  3678. Make video output lighter:
  3679. @example
  3680. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  3681. @end example
  3682. @item
  3683. Increase brightness:
  3684. @example
  3685. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  3686. @end example
  3687. @end itemize
  3688. @section colorchannelmixer
  3689. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  3690. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  3691. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  3692. modify is red, the output value will be:
  3693. @example
  3694. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  3695. @end example
  3696. The filter accepts the following options:
  3697. @table @option
  3698. @item rr
  3699. @item rg
  3700. @item rb
  3701. @item ra
  3702. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  3703. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  3704. @item gr
  3705. @item gg
  3706. @item gb
  3707. @item ga
  3708. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  3709. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  3710. @item br
  3711. @item bg
  3712. @item bb
  3713. @item ba
  3714. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  3715. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  3716. @item ar
  3717. @item ag
  3718. @item ab
  3719. @item aa
  3720. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  3721. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  3722. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  3723. @end table
  3724. @subsection Examples
  3725. @itemize
  3726. @item
  3727. Convert source to grayscale:
  3728. @example
  3729. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  3730. @end example
  3731. @item
  3732. Simulate sepia tones:
  3733. @example
  3734. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  3735. @end example
  3736. @end itemize
  3737. @section colormatrix
  3738. Convert color matrix.
  3739. The filter accepts the following options:
  3740. @table @option
  3741. @item src
  3742. @item dst
  3743. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  3744. specified.
  3745. The accepted values are:
  3746. @table @samp
  3747. @item bt709
  3748. BT.709
  3749. @item bt601
  3750. BT.601
  3751. @item smpte240m
  3752. SMPTE-240M
  3753. @item fcc
  3754. FCC
  3755. @end table
  3756. @end table
  3757. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  3758. @example
  3759. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  3760. @end example
  3761. @section convolution
  3762. Apply convolution 3x3 or 5x5 filter.
  3763. The filter accepts the following options:
  3764. @table @option
  3765. @item 0m
  3766. @item 1m
  3767. @item 2m
  3768. @item 3m
  3769. Set matrix for each plane.
  3770. Matrix is sequence of 9 or 25 signed integers.
  3771. @item 0rdiv
  3772. @item 1rdiv
  3773. @item 2rdiv
  3774. @item 3rdiv
  3775. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  3776. @item 0bias
  3777. @item 1bias
  3778. @item 2bias
  3779. @item 3bias
  3780. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  3781. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  3782. @end table
  3783. @subsection Examples
  3784. @itemize
  3785. @item
  3786. Apply sharpen:
  3787. @example
  3788. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  3789. @end example
  3790. @item
  3791. Apply blur:
  3792. @example
  3793. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  3794. @end example
  3795. @item
  3796. Apply edge enhance:
  3797. @example
  3798. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  3799. @end example
  3800. @item
  3801. Apply edge detect:
  3802. @example
  3803. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  3804. @end example
  3805. @item
  3806. Apply emboss:
  3807. @example
  3808. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  3809. @end example
  3810. @end itemize
  3811. @section copy
  3812. Copy the input source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  3813. testing purposes.
  3814. @section crop
  3815. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  3816. It accepts the following parameters:
  3817. @table @option
  3818. @item w, out_w
  3819. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  3820. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  3821. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  3822. @item h, out_h
  3823. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  3824. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  3825. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  3826. @item x
  3827. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  3828. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  3829. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  3830. @item y
  3831. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  3832. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  3833. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  3834. @item keep_aspect
  3835. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  3836. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  3837. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  3838. @end table
  3839. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  3840. expressions containing the following constants:
  3841. @table @option
  3842. @item x
  3843. @item y
  3844. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  3845. each new frame.
  3846. @item in_w
  3847. @item in_h
  3848. The input width and height.
  3849. @item iw
  3850. @item ih
  3851. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  3852. @item out_w
  3853. @item out_h
  3854. The output (cropped) width and height.
  3855. @item ow
  3856. @item oh
  3857. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  3858. @item a
  3859. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  3860. @item sar
  3861. input sample aspect ratio
  3862. @item dar
  3863. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  3864. @item hsub
  3865. @item vsub
  3866. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  3867. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  3868. @item n
  3869. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  3870. @item pos
  3871. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  3872. @item t
  3873. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  3874. @end table
  3875. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  3876. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  3877. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  3878. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  3879. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  3880. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  3881. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  3882. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  3883. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  3884. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  3885. @subsection Examples
  3886. @itemize
  3887. @item
  3888. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  3889. @example
  3890. crop=100:100:12:34
  3891. @end example
  3892. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  3893. @example
  3894. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  3895. @end example
  3896. @item
  3897. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  3898. @example
  3899. crop=100:100
  3900. @end example
  3901. @item
  3902. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  3903. @example
  3904. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  3905. @end example
  3906. @item
  3907. Crop the input video central square:
  3908. @example
  3909. crop=out_w=in_h
  3910. crop=in_h
  3911. @end example
  3912. @item
  3913. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  3914. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  3915. corner of the input image.
  3916. @example
  3917. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  3918. @end example
  3919. @item
  3920. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  3921. the top and bottom borders
  3922. @example
  3923. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  3924. @end example
  3925. @item
  3926. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  3927. @example
  3928. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  3929. @end example
  3930. @item
  3931. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  3932. @example
  3933. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  3934. @end example
  3935. @item
  3936. Apply trembling effect:
  3937. @example
  3938. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  3939. @end example
  3940. @item
  3941. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  3942. @example
  3943. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  3944. @end example
  3945. @item
  3946. Set x depending on the value of y:
  3947. @example
  3948. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  3949. @end example
  3950. @end itemize
  3951. @subsection Commands
  3952. This filter supports the following commands:
  3953. @table @option
  3954. @item w, out_w
  3955. @item h, out_h
  3956. @item x
  3957. @item y
  3958. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  3959. in the input video.
  3960. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  3961. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  3962. value.
  3963. @end table
  3964. @section cropdetect
  3965. Auto-detect the crop size.
  3966. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  3967. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  3968. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  3969. It accepts the following parameters:
  3970. @table @option
  3971. @item limit
  3972. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  3973. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8bit based formats). An intensity
  3974. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  3975. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  3976. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  3977. @item round
  3978. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  3979. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  3980. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  3981. encoding to most video codecs.
  3982. @item reset_count, reset
  3983. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  3984. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  3985. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  3986. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  3987. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  3988. playback.
  3989. @end table
  3990. @anchor{curves}
  3991. @section curves
  3992. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  3993. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  3994. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  3995. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  3996. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  3997. the output frame.
  3998. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  3999. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  4000. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  4001. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  4002. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  4003. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  4004. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  4005. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  4006. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  4007. If there is no key point defined in @code{x=0}, the filter will automatically
  4008. insert a @var{(0;0)} point. In the same way, if there is no key point defined
  4009. in @code{x=1}, the filter will automatically insert a @var{(1;1)} point.
  4010. The filter accepts the following options:
  4011. @table @option
  4012. @item preset
  4013. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  4014. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  4015. options takes priority on the preset values.
  4016. Available presets are:
  4017. @table @samp
  4018. @item none
  4019. @item color_negative
  4020. @item cross_process
  4021. @item darker
  4022. @item increase_contrast
  4023. @item lighter
  4024. @item linear_contrast
  4025. @item medium_contrast
  4026. @item negative
  4027. @item strong_contrast
  4028. @item vintage
  4029. @end table
  4030. Default is @code{none}.
  4031. @item master, m
  4032. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  4033. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  4034. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  4035. post-processing LUT.
  4036. @item red, r
  4037. Set the key points for the red component.
  4038. @item green, g
  4039. Set the key points for the green component.
  4040. @item blue, b
  4041. Set the key points for the blue component.
  4042. @item all
  4043. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  4044. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  4045. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  4046. @option{all} setting.
  4047. @item psfile
  4048. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  4049. @end table
  4050. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  4051. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  4052. @subsection Examples
  4053. @itemize
  4054. @item
  4055. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  4056. @example
  4057. curves=blue='0.5/0.58'
  4058. @end example
  4059. @item
  4060. Vintage effect:
  4061. @example
  4062. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0.50/0.48':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  4063. @end example
  4064. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  4065. @table @var
  4066. @item red
  4067. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  4068. @item green
  4069. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  4070. @item blue
  4071. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  4072. @end table
  4073. @item
  4074. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  4075. @example
  4076. curves=preset=vintage
  4077. @end example
  4078. @item
  4079. Or simply:
  4080. @example
  4081. curves=vintage
  4082. @end example
  4083. @item
  4084. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  4085. @example
  4086. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0.45/0.53'
  4087. @end example
  4088. @end itemize
  4089. @section dctdnoiz
  4090. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  4091. This filter is not designed for real time.
  4092. The filter accepts the following options:
  4093. @table @option
  4094. @item sigma, s
  4095. Set the noise sigma constant.
  4096. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  4097. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  4098. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  4099. Default is @code{0}.
  4100. @item overlap
  4101. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  4102. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  4103. risk of various artefacts.
  4104. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  4105. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  4106. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  4107. @item expr, e
  4108. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  4109. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  4110. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  4111. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  4112. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  4113. variable.
  4114. @item n
  4115. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  4116. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  4117. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  4118. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  4119. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  4120. better de-noising.
  4121. @end table
  4122. @subsection Examples
  4123. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  4124. @example
  4125. dctdnoiz=4.5
  4126. @end example
  4127. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  4128. @example
  4129. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  4130. @end example
  4131. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  4132. @example
  4133. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  4134. @end example
  4135. @section deband
  4136. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  4137. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  4138. The filter accepts the following options:
  4139. @table @option
  4140. @item 1thr
  4141. @item 2thr
  4142. @item 3thr
  4143. @item 4thr
  4144. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  4145. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  4146. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  4147. it will be considered as banded.
  4148. @item range, r
  4149. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  4150. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  4151. will be used.
  4152. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  4153. @item direction, d
  4154. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  4155. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  4156. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  4157. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  4158. column.
  4159. @item blur
  4160. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  4161. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  4162. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  4163. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  4164. @end table
  4165. @anchor{decimate}
  4166. @section decimate
  4167. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  4168. The filter accepts the following options:
  4169. @table @option
  4170. @item cycle
  4171. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  4172. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  4173. Default is @code{5}.
  4174. @item dupthresh
  4175. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  4176. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  4177. is @code{1.1}
  4178. @item scthresh
  4179. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  4180. @item blockx
  4181. @item blocky
  4182. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  4183. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  4184. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  4185. @item ppsrc
  4186. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  4187. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  4188. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  4189. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  4190. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  4191. @code{0}.
  4192. @item chroma
  4193. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  4194. @code{1}.
  4195. @end table
  4196. @section deflate
  4197. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  4198. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  4199. only values lower than the pixel.
  4200. It accepts the following options:
  4201. @table @option
  4202. @item threshold0
  4203. @item threshold1
  4204. @item threshold2
  4205. @item threshold3
  4206. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  4207. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  4208. @end table
  4209. @section dejudder
  4210. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  4211. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  4212. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  4213. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  4214. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  4215. rate video.
  4216. The option available in this filter is:
  4217. @table @option
  4218. @item cycle
  4219. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  4220. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  4221. @table @samp
  4222. @item 4
  4223. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  4224. @item 5
  4225. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  4226. @item 20
  4227. If a mixture of the two.
  4228. @end table
  4229. The default is @samp{4}.
  4230. @end table
  4231. @section delogo
  4232. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  4233. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  4234. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  4235. It accepts the following parameters:
  4236. @table @option
  4237. @item x
  4238. @item y
  4239. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  4240. specified.
  4241. @item w
  4242. @item h
  4243. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  4244. specified.
  4245. @item band, t
  4246. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  4247. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  4248. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  4249. is not recommended.
  4250. @item show
  4251. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  4252. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  4253. The default value is 0.
  4254. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  4255. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  4256. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  4257. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  4258. @end table
  4259. @subsection Examples
  4260. @itemize
  4261. @item
  4262. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  4263. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  4264. @example
  4265. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  4266. @end example
  4267. @end itemize
  4268. @section deshake
  4269. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  4270. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  4271. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  4272. The filter accepts the following options:
  4273. @table @option
  4274. @item x
  4275. @item y
  4276. @item w
  4277. @item h
  4278. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  4279. vectors.
  4280. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  4281. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  4282. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  4283. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  4284. box.
  4285. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  4286. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  4287. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  4288. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  4289. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  4290. Default - search the whole frame.
  4291. @item rx
  4292. @item ry
  4293. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  4294. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  4295. @item edge
  4296. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  4297. frame. Available values are:
  4298. @table @samp
  4299. @item blank, 0
  4300. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  4301. @item original, 1
  4302. Original image at blank locations
  4303. @item clamp, 2
  4304. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  4305. @item mirror, 3
  4306. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  4307. @end table
  4308. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  4309. @item blocksize
  4310. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  4311. default 8.
  4312. @item contrast
  4313. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  4314. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  4315. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  4316. @item search
  4317. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  4318. @table @samp
  4319. @item exhaustive, 0
  4320. Set exhaustive search
  4321. @item less, 1
  4322. Set less exhaustive search.
  4323. @end table
  4324. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  4325. @item filename
  4326. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  4327. specified file.
  4328. @item opencl
  4329. If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
  4330. FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
  4331. @end table
  4332. @section detelecine
  4333. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  4334. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  4335. to the telecine filter.
  4336. This filter accepts the following options:
  4337. @table @option
  4338. @item first_field
  4339. @table @samp
  4340. @item top, t
  4341. top field first
  4342. @item bottom, b
  4343. bottom field first
  4344. The default value is @code{top}.
  4345. @end table
  4346. @item pattern
  4347. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  4348. The default value is @code{23}.
  4349. @item start_frame
  4350. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  4351. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  4352. @end table
  4353. @section dilation
  4354. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  4355. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  4356. It accepts the following options:
  4357. @table @option
  4358. @item threshold0
  4359. @item threshold1
  4360. @item threshold2
  4361. @item threshold3
  4362. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  4363. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  4364. @item coordinates
  4365. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  4366. pixels are used.
  4367. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  4368. 1 2 3
  4369. 4 5
  4370. 6 7 8
  4371. @end table
  4372. @section displace
  4373. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  4374. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  4375. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  4376. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  4377. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  4378. along the y-axis.
  4379. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  4380. displacement map will be used.
  4381. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  4382. A description of the accepted options follows.
  4383. @table @option
  4384. @item edge
  4385. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  4386. Available values are:
  4387. @table @samp
  4388. @item blank
  4389. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  4390. @item smear
  4391. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  4392. @item wrap
  4393. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  4394. @end table
  4395. Default is @samp{smear}.
  4396. @end table
  4397. @subsection Examples
  4398. @itemize
  4399. @item
  4400. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  4401. @example
  4402. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  4403. @end example
  4404. @item
  4405. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  4406. @example
  4407. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  4408. @end example
  4409. @end itemize
  4410. @section drawbox
  4411. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  4412. It accepts the following parameters:
  4413. @table @option
  4414. @item x
  4415. @item y
  4416. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  4417. @item width, w
  4418. @item height, h
  4419. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  4420. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  4421. @item color, c
  4422. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  4423. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
  4424. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  4425. video with inverted luma.
  4426. @item thickness, t
  4427. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge. Default value is @code{3}.
  4428. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  4429. @end table
  4430. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  4431. following constants:
  4432. @table @option
  4433. @item dar
  4434. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  4435. @item hsub
  4436. @item vsub
  4437. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  4438. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  4439. @item in_h, ih
  4440. @item in_w, iw
  4441. The input width and height.
  4442. @item sar
  4443. The input sample aspect ratio.
  4444. @item x
  4445. @item y
  4446. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  4447. @item w
  4448. @item h
  4449. The width and height of the drawn box.
  4450. @item t
  4451. The thickness of the drawn box.
  4452. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  4453. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  4454. @end table
  4455. @subsection Examples
  4456. @itemize
  4457. @item
  4458. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  4459. @example
  4460. drawbox
  4461. @end example
  4462. @item
  4463. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  4464. @example
  4465. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  4466. @end example
  4467. The previous example can be specified as:
  4468. @example
  4469. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  4470. @end example
  4471. @item
  4472. Fill the box with pink color:
  4473. @example
  4474. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=max
  4475. @end example
  4476. @item
  4477. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  4478. @example
  4479. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  4480. @end example
  4481. @end itemize
  4482. @section drawgraph, adrawgraph
  4483. Draw a graph using input video or audio metadata.
  4484. It accepts the following parameters:
  4485. @table @option
  4486. @item m1
  4487. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  4488. @item fg1
  4489. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  4490. @item m2
  4491. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  4492. @item fg2
  4493. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  4494. @item m3
  4495. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  4496. @item fg3
  4497. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  4498. @item m4
  4499. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  4500. @item fg4
  4501. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  4502. @item min
  4503. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  4504. @item max
  4505. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  4506. @item bg
  4507. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  4508. @item mode
  4509. Set graph mode.
  4510. Available values for mode is:
  4511. @table @samp
  4512. @item bar
  4513. @item dot
  4514. @item line
  4515. @end table
  4516. Default is @code{line}.
  4517. @item slide
  4518. Set slide mode.
  4519. Available values for slide is:
  4520. @table @samp
  4521. @item frame
  4522. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  4523. @item replace
  4524. Replace old columns with new ones.
  4525. @item scroll
  4526. Scroll from right to left.
  4527. @item rscroll
  4528. Scroll from left to right.
  4529. @end table
  4530. Default is @code{frame}.
  4531. @item size
  4532. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  4533. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  4534. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  4535. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  4536. @table @option
  4537. @item MIN
  4538. Minimal value of metadata value.
  4539. @item MAX
  4540. Maximal value of metadata value.
  4541. @item VAL
  4542. Current metadata key value.
  4543. @end table
  4544. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  4545. @end table
  4546. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  4547. @example
  4548. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  4549. @end example
  4550. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  4551. @example
  4552. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  4553. @end example
  4554. @section drawgrid
  4555. Draw a grid on the input image.
  4556. It accepts the following parameters:
  4557. @table @option
  4558. @item x
  4559. @item y
  4560. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  4561. @item width, w
  4562. @item height, h
  4563. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  4564. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  4565. framed. Default to 0.
  4566. @item color, c
  4567. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  4568. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
  4569. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  4570. video with inverted luma.
  4571. @item thickness, t
  4572. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  4573. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  4574. @end table
  4575. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  4576. following constants:
  4577. @table @option
  4578. @item dar
  4579. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  4580. @item hsub
  4581. @item vsub
  4582. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  4583. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  4584. @item in_h, ih
  4585. @item in_w, iw
  4586. The input grid cell width and height.
  4587. @item sar
  4588. The input sample aspect ratio.
  4589. @item x
  4590. @item y
  4591. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  4592. @item w
  4593. @item h
  4594. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  4595. @item t
  4596. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  4597. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  4598. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  4599. @end table
  4600. @subsection Examples
  4601. @itemize
  4602. @item
  4603. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  4604. @example
  4605. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  4606. @end example
  4607. @item
  4608. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  4609. @example
  4610. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  4611. @end example
  4612. @end itemize
  4613. @anchor{drawtext}
  4614. @section drawtext
  4615. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  4616. libfreetype library.
  4617. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4618. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  4619. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  4620. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  4621. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4622. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  4623. @subsection Syntax
  4624. It accepts the following parameters:
  4625. @table @option
  4626. @item box
  4627. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  4628. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  4629. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  4630. @item boxborderw
  4631. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  4632. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  4633. @item boxcolor
  4634. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  4635. option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  4636. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  4637. @item borderw
  4638. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  4639. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  4640. @item bordercolor
  4641. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  4642. option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  4643. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  4644. @item expansion
  4645. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  4646. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  4647. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  4648. below for details.
  4649. @item fix_bounds
  4650. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  4651. @item fontcolor
  4652. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  4653. the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  4654. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  4655. @item fontcolor_expr
  4656. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  4657. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  4658. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  4659. @item font
  4660. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  4661. @item fontfile
  4662. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  4663. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  4664. @item draw
  4665. This option does not exist, please see the timeline system
  4666. @item alpha
  4667. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  4668. be either a number between 0.0 and 1.0
  4669. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} do.
  4670. The default value is 1.
  4671. Please see fontcolor_expr
  4672. @item fontsize
  4673. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  4674. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  4675. @item text_shaping
  4676. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  4677. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  4678. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  4679. By default 1 (if supported).
  4680. @item ft_load_flags
  4681. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  4682. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  4683. a combination of the following values:
  4684. @table @var
  4685. @item default
  4686. @item no_scale
  4687. @item no_hinting
  4688. @item render
  4689. @item no_bitmap
  4690. @item vertical_layout
  4691. @item force_autohint
  4692. @item crop_bitmap
  4693. @item pedantic
  4694. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  4695. @item no_recurse
  4696. @item ignore_transform
  4697. @item monochrome
  4698. @item linear_design
  4699. @item no_autohint
  4700. @end table
  4701. Default value is "default".
  4702. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  4703. libfreetype flags.
  4704. @item shadowcolor
  4705. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  4706. syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  4707. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  4708. @item shadowx
  4709. @item shadowy
  4710. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  4711. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  4712. values. The default value for both is "0".
  4713. @item start_number
  4714. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  4715. is "0".
  4716. @item tabsize
  4717. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  4718. Default value is 4.
  4719. @item timecode
  4720. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  4721. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  4722. option must be specified.
  4723. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  4724. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only).
  4725. @item text
  4726. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  4727. encoded characters.
  4728. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  4729. @var{textfile}.
  4730. @item textfile
  4731. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  4732. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  4733. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  4734. parameter @var{text}.
  4735. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  4736. @item reload
  4737. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  4738. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  4739. @item x
  4740. @item y
  4741. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  4742. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  4743. output image.
  4744. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  4745. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  4746. @end table
  4747. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  4748. following constants and functions:
  4749. @table @option
  4750. @item dar
  4751. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  4752. @item hsub
  4753. @item vsub
  4754. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  4755. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  4756. @item line_h, lh
  4757. the height of each text line
  4758. @item main_h, h, H
  4759. the input height
  4760. @item main_w, w, W
  4761. the input width
  4762. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  4763. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  4764. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  4765. glyphs.
  4766. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  4767. upwards.
  4768. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  4769. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  4770. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  4771. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  4772. upwards.
  4773. @item max_glyph_h
  4774. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  4775. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  4776. @var{descent}.
  4777. @item max_glyph_w
  4778. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  4779. contained in the rendered text
  4780. @item n
  4781. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  4782. @item rand(min, max)
  4783. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  4784. @item sar
  4785. The input sample aspect ratio.
  4786. @item t
  4787. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  4788. @item text_h, th
  4789. the height of the rendered text
  4790. @item text_w, tw
  4791. the width of the rendered text
  4792. @item x
  4793. @item y
  4794. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  4795. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  4796. each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  4797. @end table
  4798. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  4799. @subsection Text expansion
  4800. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  4801. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  4802. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  4803. feature is deprecated.
  4804. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  4805. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  4806. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  4807. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  4808. the second character.
  4809. Sequence of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  4810. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  4811. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  4812. they should be escaped.
  4813. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  4814. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  4815. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  4816. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  4817. problems.
  4818. The following functions are available:
  4819. @table @command
  4820. @item expr, e
  4821. The expression evaluation result.
  4822. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  4823. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  4824. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  4825. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  4826. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  4827. value.
  4828. @item expr_int_format, eif
  4829. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  4830. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  4831. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  4832. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  4833. @code{printf} function.
  4834. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  4835. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  4836. @item gmtime
  4837. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  4838. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  4839. @item localtime
  4840. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  4841. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  4842. @item metadata
  4843. Frame metadata. It must take one argument specifying metadata key.
  4844. @item n, frame_num
  4845. The frame number, starting from 0.
  4846. @item pict_type
  4847. A 1 character description of the current picture type.
  4848. @item pts
  4849. The timestamp of the current frame.
  4850. It can take up to three arguments.
  4851. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  4852. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  4853. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  4854. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  4855. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  4856. local time zone time.
  4857. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  4858. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  4859. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  4860. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  4861. @end table
  4862. @subsection Examples
  4863. @itemize
  4864. @item
  4865. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  4866. optional parameters.
  4867. @example
  4868. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  4869. @end example
  4870. @item
  4871. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  4872. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  4873. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  4874. opacity of 20%.
  4875. @example
  4876. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  4877. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  4878. @end example
  4879. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  4880. within the parameter list.
  4881. @item
  4882. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  4883. @example
  4884. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  4885. @end example
  4886. @item
  4887. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  4888. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  4889. with no newlines.
  4890. @example
  4891. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  4892. @end example
  4893. @item
  4894. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  4895. @example
  4896. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  4897. @end example
  4898. @item
  4899. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  4900. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  4901. @example
  4902. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  4903. @end example
  4904. @item
  4905. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  4906. @example
  4907. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  4908. @end example
  4909. @item
  4910. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  4911. @example
  4912. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  4913. @end example
  4914. @item
  4915. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  4916. @example
  4917. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  4918. @end example
  4919. @item
  4920. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  4921. @example
  4922. #!/bin/sh
  4923. DS=1.0 # display start
  4924. DE=10.0 # display end
  4925. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  4926. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  4927. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  4928. @end example
  4929. @end itemize
  4930. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  4931. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  4932. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  4933. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  4934. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  4935. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  4936. @section edgedetect
  4937. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  4938. The filter accepts the following options:
  4939. @table @option
  4940. @item low
  4941. @item high
  4942. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  4943. algorithm.
  4944. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  4945. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  4946. by the low threshold.
  4947. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  4948. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  4949. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  4950. is @code{50/255}.
  4951. @item mode
  4952. Define the drawing mode.
  4953. @table @samp
  4954. @item wires
  4955. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  4956. @item colormix
  4957. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  4958. @end table
  4959. Default value is @var{wires}.
  4960. @end table
  4961. @subsection Examples
  4962. @itemize
  4963. @item
  4964. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  4965. @example
  4966. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  4967. @end example
  4968. @item
  4969. Painting effect without thresholding:
  4970. @example
  4971. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  4972. @end example
  4973. @end itemize
  4974. @section eq
  4975. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  4976. The filter accepts the following options:
  4977. @table @option
  4978. @item contrast
  4979. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  4980. @code{-2.0} to @code{2.0}. The default value is "1".
  4981. @item brightness
  4982. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  4983. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  4984. @item saturation
  4985. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  4986. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  4987. @item gamma
  4988. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  4989. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  4990. @item gamma_r
  4991. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  4992. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  4993. @item gamma_g
  4994. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  4995. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  4996. @item gamma_b
  4997. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  4998. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  4999. @item gamma_weight
  5000. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  5001. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  5002. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  5003. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  5004. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  5005. full strength. Default is "1".
  5006. @item eval
  5007. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  5008. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  5009. It accepts the following values:
  5010. @table @samp
  5011. @item init
  5012. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  5013. when a command is processed
  5014. @item frame
  5015. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  5016. @end table
  5017. Default value is @samp{init}.
  5018. @end table
  5019. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  5020. @table @option
  5021. @item n
  5022. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  5023. @item pos
  5024. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  5025. unspecified
  5026. @item r
  5027. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  5028. @item t
  5029. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  5030. @end table
  5031. @subsection Commands
  5032. The filter supports the following commands:
  5033. @table @option
  5034. @item contrast
  5035. Set the contrast expression.
  5036. @item brightness
  5037. Set the brightness expression.
  5038. @item saturation
  5039. Set the saturation expression.
  5040. @item gamma
  5041. Set the gamma expression.
  5042. @item gamma_r
  5043. Set the gamma_r expression.
  5044. @item gamma_g
  5045. Set gamma_g expression.
  5046. @item gamma_b
  5047. Set gamma_b expression.
  5048. @item gamma_weight
  5049. Set gamma_weight expression.
  5050. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5051. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5052. value.
  5053. @end table
  5054. @section erosion
  5055. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  5056. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  5057. It accepts the following options:
  5058. @table @option
  5059. @item threshold0
  5060. @item threshold1
  5061. @item threshold2
  5062. @item threshold3
  5063. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  5064. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  5065. @item coordinates
  5066. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  5067. pixels are used.
  5068. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  5069. 1 2 3
  5070. 4 5
  5071. 6 7 8
  5072. @end table
  5073. @section extractplanes
  5074. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  5075. separate grayscale video streams.
  5076. The filter accepts the following option:
  5077. @table @option
  5078. @item planes
  5079. Set plane(s) to extract.
  5080. Available values for planes are:
  5081. @table @samp
  5082. @item y
  5083. @item u
  5084. @item v
  5085. @item a
  5086. @item r
  5087. @item g
  5088. @item b
  5089. @end table
  5090. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  5091. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  5092. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  5093. @end table
  5094. @subsection Examples
  5095. @itemize
  5096. @item
  5097. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  5098. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  5099. @example
  5100. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  5101. @end example
  5102. @end itemize
  5103. @section elbg
  5104. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  5105. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  5106. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  5107. of distinct output colors.
  5108. This filter accepts the following options.
  5109. @table @option
  5110. @item codebook_length, l
  5111. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  5112. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  5113. @item nb_steps, n
  5114. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  5115. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  5116. computation time. Default value is 1.
  5117. @item seed, s
  5118. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  5119. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  5120. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  5121. @item pal8
  5122. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  5123. length greater than 256.
  5124. @end table
  5125. @section fade
  5126. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  5127. It accepts the following parameters:
  5128. @table @option
  5129. @item type, t
  5130. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  5131. effect.
  5132. Default is @code{in}.
  5133. @item start_frame, s
  5134. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  5135. effect at. Default is 0.
  5136. @item nb_frames, n
  5137. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  5138. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  5139. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  5140. selected @option{color}.
  5141. Default is 25.
  5142. @item alpha
  5143. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  5144. Default value is 0.
  5145. @item start_time, st
  5146. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  5147. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  5148. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  5149. @item duration, d
  5150. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  5151. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  5152. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  5153. selected @option{color}.
  5154. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  5155. (nb_frames is used by default).
  5156. @item color, c
  5157. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  5158. @end table
  5159. @subsection Examples
  5160. @itemize
  5161. @item
  5162. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  5163. @example
  5164. fade=in:0:30
  5165. @end example
  5166. The command above is equivalent to:
  5167. @example
  5168. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  5169. @end example
  5170. @item
  5171. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  5172. @example
  5173. fade=out:155:45
  5174. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  5175. @end example
  5176. @item
  5177. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  5178. @example
  5179. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  5180. @end example
  5181. @item
  5182. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  5183. @example
  5184. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  5185. @end example
  5186. @item
  5187. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  5188. @example
  5189. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  5190. @end example
  5191. @item
  5192. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  5193. @example
  5194. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  5195. @end example
  5196. @end itemize
  5197. @section fftfilt
  5198. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  5199. @table @option
  5200. @item dc_Y
  5201. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  5202. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  5203. value is set to @code{0}.
  5204. @item dc_U
  5205. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  5206. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  5207. default value is set to @code{0}.
  5208. @item dc_V
  5209. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  5210. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  5211. default value is set to @code{0}.
  5212. @item weight_Y
  5213. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  5214. @item weight_U
  5215. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  5216. @item weight_V
  5217. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  5218. The filter accepts the following variables:
  5219. @item X
  5220. @item Y
  5221. The coordinates of the current sample.
  5222. @item W
  5223. @item H
  5224. The width and height of the image.
  5225. @end table
  5226. @subsection Examples
  5227. @itemize
  5228. @item
  5229. High-pass:
  5230. @example
  5231. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  5232. @end example
  5233. @item
  5234. Low-pass:
  5235. @example
  5236. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  5237. @end example
  5238. @item
  5239. Sharpen:
  5240. @example
  5241. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  5242. @end example
  5243. @item
  5244. Blur:
  5245. @example
  5246. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  5247. @end example
  5248. @end itemize
  5249. @section field
  5250. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  5251. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  5252. non-interlaced.
  5253. The filter accepts the following options:
  5254. @table @option
  5255. @item type
  5256. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  5257. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  5258. @code{bottom}).
  5259. @end table
  5260. @section fieldhint
  5261. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  5262. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  5263. @table @option
  5264. @item hint
  5265. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  5266. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  5267. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  5268. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  5269. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  5270. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  5271. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  5272. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  5273. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  5274. it will be marked same as input frame.
  5275. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  5276. @item mode
  5277. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  5278. @end table
  5279. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  5280. @example
  5281. 0,0 - # first frame
  5282. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  5283. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  5284. 1,0 -
  5285. 0,0 -
  5286. 0,0 -
  5287. 1,0 -
  5288. 1,0 -
  5289. 1,0 -
  5290. 0,0 -
  5291. 0,0 -
  5292. 1,0 -
  5293. 1,0 -
  5294. 1,0 -
  5295. 0,0 -
  5296. @end example
  5297. @section fieldmatch
  5298. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  5299. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  5300. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  5301. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  5302. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  5303. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  5304. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  5305. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  5306. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  5307. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  5308. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  5309. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  5310. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  5311. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  5312. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  5313. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  5314. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  5315. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  5316. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  5317. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  5318. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  5319. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  5320. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  5321. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  5322. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  5323. The filter accepts the following options:
  5324. @table @option
  5325. @item order
  5326. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  5327. @table @samp
  5328. @item auto
  5329. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  5330. @item bff
  5331. Assume bottom field first.
  5332. @item tff
  5333. Assume top field first.
  5334. @end table
  5335. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  5336. stream.
  5337. Default value is @var{auto}.
  5338. @item mode
  5339. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  5340. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  5341. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  5342. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  5343. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  5344. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  5345. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  5346. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  5347. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  5348. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  5349. Available values are:
  5350. @table @samp
  5351. @item pc
  5352. 2-way matching (p/c)
  5353. @item pc_n
  5354. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  5355. @item pc_u
  5356. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  5357. @item pc_n_ub
  5358. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  5359. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  5360. @item pcn
  5361. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  5362. @item pcn_ub
  5363. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  5364. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  5365. @end table
  5366. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  5367. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  5368. @var{top}).
  5369. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  5370. the slowest.
  5371. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  5372. @item ppsrc
  5373. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  5374. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  5375. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  5376. VFM/TFM.
  5377. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  5378. @item field
  5379. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  5380. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  5381. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  5382. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  5383. @table @samp
  5384. @item auto
  5385. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  5386. @item bottom
  5387. Match from the bottom field.
  5388. @item top
  5389. Match from the top field.
  5390. @end table
  5391. Default value is @var{auto}.
  5392. @item mchroma
  5393. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  5394. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  5395. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  5396. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  5397. the cost of some accuracy.
  5398. Default value is @code{1}.
  5399. @item y0
  5400. @item y1
  5401. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  5402. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  5403. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  5404. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  5405. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  5406. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  5407. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  5408. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  5409. @item scthresh
  5410. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  5411. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  5412. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  5413. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  5414. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  5415. @item combmatch
  5416. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  5417. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  5418. final match. Available values are:
  5419. @table @samp
  5420. @item none
  5421. No final matching based on combed scores.
  5422. @item sc
  5423. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  5424. @item full
  5425. Use combed scores all the time.
  5426. @end table
  5427. Default is @var{sc}.
  5428. @item combdbg
  5429. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  5430. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  5431. Available values are:
  5432. @table @samp
  5433. @item none
  5434. No forced calculation.
  5435. @item pcn
  5436. Force p/c/n calculations.
  5437. @item pcnub
  5438. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  5439. @end table
  5440. Default value is @var{none}.
  5441. @item cthresh
  5442. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  5443. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  5444. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  5445. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  5446. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  5447. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  5448. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  5449. Default value is @code{9}.
  5450. @item chroma
  5451. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  5452. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  5453. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  5454. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  5455. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  5456. Default value is @code{0}.
  5457. @item blockx
  5458. @item blocky
  5459. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  5460. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  5461. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  5462. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  5463. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  5464. to 512.
  5465. Default value is @code{16}.
  5466. @item combpel
  5467. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  5468. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  5469. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  5470. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  5471. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  5472. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  5473. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  5474. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  5475. Default value is @code{80}.
  5476. @end table
  5477. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  5478. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  5479. @subsubsection p/c/n
  5480. We assume the following telecined stream:
  5481. @example
  5482. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  5483. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  5484. @end example
  5485. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  5486. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  5487. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  5488. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  5489. @example
  5490. Input stream:
  5491. T 1 2 2 3 4
  5492. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  5493. Matches: c c n n c
  5494. Output stream:
  5495. T 1 2 3 4 4
  5496. B 1 2 3 4 4
  5497. @end example
  5498. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  5499. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  5500. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  5501. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  5502. looks like this:
  5503. @example
  5504. Input stream:
  5505. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  5506. B 1 2 3 4 4
  5507. Matches: c c p p c
  5508. Output stream:
  5509. T 1 2 2 3 4
  5510. B 1 2 2 3 4
  5511. @end example
  5512. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  5513. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  5514. @itemize
  5515. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  5516. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  5517. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  5518. @end itemize
  5519. @subsubsection u/b
  5520. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  5521. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  5522. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  5523. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  5524. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  5525. @example
  5526. Match: c p n b u
  5527. x x x x x
  5528. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  5529. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  5530. x x x x x
  5531. Output frames:
  5532. 2 1 2 2 2
  5533. 2 2 2 1 3
  5534. @end example
  5535. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  5536. @example
  5537. Match: c p n b u
  5538. x x x x x
  5539. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  5540. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  5541. x x x x x
  5542. Output frames:
  5543. 2 2 2 1 2
  5544. 2 1 3 2 2
  5545. @end example
  5546. @subsection Examples
  5547. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  5548. @example
  5549. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  5550. @end example
  5551. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  5552. @example
  5553. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  5554. @end example
  5555. @section fieldorder
  5556. Transform the field order of the input video.
  5557. It accepts the following parameters:
  5558. @table @option
  5559. @item order
  5560. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  5561. for bottom field first.
  5562. @end table
  5563. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  5564. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  5565. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  5566. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  5567. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  5568. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  5569. not alter the incoming video.
  5570. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  5571. which is bottom field first.
  5572. For example:
  5573. @example
  5574. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  5575. @end example
  5576. @section fifo, afifo
  5577. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  5578. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  5579. framework.
  5580. It does not take parameters.
  5581. @section find_rect
  5582. Find a rectangular object
  5583. It accepts the following options:
  5584. @table @option
  5585. @item object
  5586. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  5587. @item threshold
  5588. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  5589. @item mipmaps
  5590. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  5591. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  5592. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  5593. @end table
  5594. @subsection Examples
  5595. @itemize
  5596. @item
  5597. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  5598. @example
  5599. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  5600. @end example
  5601. @end itemize
  5602. @section cover_rect
  5603. Cover a rectangular object
  5604. It accepts the following options:
  5605. @table @option
  5606. @item cover
  5607. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  5608. @item mode
  5609. Set covering mode.
  5610. It accepts the following values:
  5611. @table @samp
  5612. @item cover
  5613. cover it by the supplied image
  5614. @item blur
  5615. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  5616. @end table
  5617. Default value is @var{blur}.
  5618. @end table
  5619. @subsection Examples
  5620. @itemize
  5621. @item
  5622. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  5623. @example
  5624. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  5625. @end example
  5626. @end itemize
  5627. @anchor{format}
  5628. @section format
  5629. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  5630. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  5631. the next filter.
  5632. It accepts the following parameters:
  5633. @table @option
  5634. @item pix_fmts
  5635. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  5636. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  5637. @end table
  5638. @subsection Examples
  5639. @itemize
  5640. @item
  5641. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  5642. @example
  5643. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  5644. @end example
  5645. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  5646. @example
  5647. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  5648. @end example
  5649. @end itemize
  5650. @anchor{fps}
  5651. @section fps
  5652. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  5653. frames as necessary.
  5654. It accepts the following parameters:
  5655. @table @option
  5656. @item fps
  5657. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  5658. @item round
  5659. Rounding method.
  5660. Possible values are:
  5661. @table @option
  5662. @item zero
  5663. zero round towards 0
  5664. @item inf
  5665. round away from 0
  5666. @item down
  5667. round towards -infinity
  5668. @item up
  5669. round towards +infinity
  5670. @item near
  5671. round to nearest
  5672. @end table
  5673. The default is @code{near}.
  5674. @item start_time
  5675. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  5676. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  5677. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  5678. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  5679. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  5680. frames with a negative PTS.
  5681. @end table
  5682. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  5683. @var{fps}[:@var{round}].
  5684. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  5685. @subsection Examples
  5686. @itemize
  5687. @item
  5688. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  5689. @example
  5690. fps=fps=25
  5691. @end example
  5692. @item
  5693. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  5694. @example
  5695. fps=fps=film:round=near
  5696. @end example
  5697. @end itemize
  5698. @section framepack
  5699. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  5700. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  5701. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  5702. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  5703. @ref{fps} filters.
  5704. It accepts the following parameters:
  5705. @table @option
  5706. @item format
  5707. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  5708. @table @option
  5709. @item sbs
  5710. The views are next to each other (default).
  5711. @item tab
  5712. The views are on top of each other.
  5713. @item lines
  5714. The views are packed by line.
  5715. @item columns
  5716. The views are packed by column.
  5717. @item frameseq
  5718. The views are temporally interleaved.
  5719. @end table
  5720. @end table
  5721. Some examples:
  5722. @example
  5723. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  5724. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  5725. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  5726. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  5727. @end example
  5728. @section framerate
  5729. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  5730. frames.
  5731. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  5732. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  5733. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  5734. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5735. @table @option
  5736. @item fps
  5737. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  5738. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  5739. @item interp_start
  5740. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  5741. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  5742. the default is @code{15}.
  5743. @item interp_end
  5744. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  5745. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  5746. the default is @code{240}.
  5747. @item scene
  5748. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  5749. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  5750. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  5751. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  5752. The default is @code{7}.
  5753. @item flags
  5754. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  5755. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  5756. @table @option
  5757. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  5758. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  5759. This flag is enabled by default.
  5760. @end table
  5761. @end table
  5762. @section framestep
  5763. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  5764. This filter accepts the following option:
  5765. @table @option
  5766. @item step
  5767. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  5768. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  5769. @end table
  5770. @anchor{frei0r}
  5771. @section frei0r
  5772. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  5773. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  5774. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  5775. It accepts the following parameters:
  5776. @table @option
  5777. @item filter_name
  5778. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  5779. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  5780. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREIOR_PATH}.
  5781. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  5782. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  5783. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  5784. @item filter_params
  5785. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  5786. @end table
  5787. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  5788. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  5789. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  5790. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or by a color description specified in the "Color"
  5791. section in the ffmpeg-utils manual), a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  5792. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  5793. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  5794. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  5795. @subsection Examples
  5796. @itemize
  5797. @item
  5798. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  5799. @example
  5800. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  5801. @end example
  5802. @item
  5803. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  5804. @example
  5805. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  5806. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  5807. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  5808. @end example
  5809. @item
  5810. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  5811. positions:
  5812. @example
  5813. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  5814. @end example
  5815. @end itemize
  5816. For more information, see
  5817. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  5818. @section fspp
  5819. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  5820. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  5821. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  5822. This allows for much higher speed.
  5823. The filter accepts the following options:
  5824. @table @option
  5825. @item quality
  5826. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  5827. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  5828. @item qp
  5829. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  5830. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  5831. @item strength
  5832. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  5833. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  5834. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  5835. @item use_bframe_qp
  5836. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  5837. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  5838. @code{0} (not enabled).
  5839. @end table
  5840. @section geq
  5841. The filter accepts the following options:
  5842. @table @option
  5843. @item lum_expr, lum
  5844. Set the luminance expression.
  5845. @item cb_expr, cb
  5846. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  5847. @item cr_expr, cr
  5848. Set the chrominance red expression.
  5849. @item alpha_expr, a
  5850. Set the alpha expression.
  5851. @item red_expr, r
  5852. Set the red expression.
  5853. @item green_expr, g
  5854. Set the green expression.
  5855. @item blue_expr, b
  5856. Set the blue expression.
  5857. @end table
  5858. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  5859. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  5860. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  5861. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  5862. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  5863. colorspace.
  5864. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  5865. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  5866. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  5867. to the luminance expression.
  5868. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  5869. @table @option
  5870. @item N
  5871. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5872. @item X
  5873. @item Y
  5874. The coordinates of the current sample.
  5875. @item W
  5876. @item H
  5877. The width and height of the image.
  5878. @item SW
  5879. @item SH
  5880. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  5881. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  5882. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  5883. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  5884. @item T
  5885. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5886. @item p(x, y)
  5887. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  5888. plane.
  5889. @item lum(x, y)
  5890. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  5891. plane.
  5892. @item cb(x, y)
  5893. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  5894. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  5895. @item cr(x, y)
  5896. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  5897. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  5898. @item r(x, y)
  5899. @item g(x, y)
  5900. @item b(x, y)
  5901. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  5902. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  5903. @item alpha(x, y)
  5904. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  5905. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  5906. @end table
  5907. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  5908. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  5909. @subsection Examples
  5910. @itemize
  5911. @item
  5912. Flip the image horizontally:
  5913. @example
  5914. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  5915. @end example
  5916. @item
  5917. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  5918. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  5919. @example
  5920. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  5921. @end example
  5922. @item
  5923. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  5924. @example
  5925. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  5926. @end example
  5927. @item
  5928. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  5929. @example
  5930. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  5931. @end example
  5932. @item
  5933. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  5934. @example
  5935. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  5936. @end example
  5937. @item
  5938. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  5939. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  5940. @example
  5941. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  5942. @end example
  5943. @end itemize
  5944. @section gradfun
  5945. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  5946. regions by truncation to 8bit color depth.
  5947. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  5948. dither them.
  5949. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  5950. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  5951. bring back the bands.
  5952. It accepts the following parameters:
  5953. @table @option
  5954. @item strength
  5955. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  5956. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  5957. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  5958. valid range.
  5959. @item radius
  5960. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  5961. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  5962. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  5963. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  5964. @end table
  5965. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  5966. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  5967. @subsection Examples
  5968. @itemize
  5969. @item
  5970. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  5971. @example
  5972. gradfun=3.5:8
  5973. @end example
  5974. @item
  5975. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  5976. value):
  5977. @example
  5978. gradfun=radius=8
  5979. @end example
  5980. @end itemize
  5981. @anchor{haldclut}
  5982. @section haldclut
  5983. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  5984. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  5985. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  5986. The filter accepts the following options:
  5987. @table @option
  5988. @item shortest
  5989. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  5990. @item repeatlast
  5991. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  5992. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  5993. Default is @code{1}.
  5994. @end table
  5995. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  5996. filters share the same internals).
  5997. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  5998. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  5999. @subsection Workflow examples
  6000. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  6001. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  6002. @example
  6003. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  6004. @end example
  6005. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  6006. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  6007. @example
  6008. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  6009. @end example
  6010. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  6011. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  6012. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  6013. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  6014. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  6015. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  6016. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  6017. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  6018. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  6019. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  6020. @code{haldclut} filter:
  6021. @example
  6022. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  6023. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  6024. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  6025. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  6026. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  6027. @end example
  6028. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  6029. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  6030. the color changes.
  6031. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  6032. @example
  6033. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  6034. @end example
  6035. @section hflip
  6036. Flip the input video horizontally.
  6037. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  6038. @example
  6039. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  6040. @end example
  6041. @section histeq
  6042. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  6043. per-frame basis.
  6044. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  6045. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  6046. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  6047. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  6048. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  6049. video.
  6050. The filter accepts the following options:
  6051. @table @option
  6052. @item strength
  6053. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  6054. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  6055. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  6056. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  6057. @item intensity
  6058. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  6059. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  6060. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  6061. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  6062. @item antibanding
  6063. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  6064. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  6065. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  6066. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  6067. @end table
  6068. @section histogram
  6069. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  6070. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  6071. distribution in an image.
  6072. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  6073. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  6074. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  6075. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  6076. The filter accepts the following options:
  6077. @table @option
  6078. @item level_height
  6079. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  6080. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  6081. @item scale_height
  6082. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  6083. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  6084. @item display_mode
  6085. Set display mode.
  6086. It accepts the following values:
  6087. @table @samp
  6088. @item parade
  6089. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  6090. @item overlay
  6091. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  6092. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  6093. over one another.
  6094. @end table
  6095. Default is @code{parade}.
  6096. @item levels_mode
  6097. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  6098. Default is @code{linear}.
  6099. @item components
  6100. Set what color components to display.
  6101. Default is @code{7}.
  6102. @end table
  6103. @subsection Examples
  6104. @itemize
  6105. @item
  6106. Calculate and draw histogram:
  6107. @example
  6108. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  6109. @end example
  6110. @end itemize
  6111. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  6112. @section hqdn3d
  6113. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  6114. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  6115. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  6116. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6117. @table @option
  6118. @item luma_spatial
  6119. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  6120. It defaults to 4.0.
  6121. @item chroma_spatial
  6122. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  6123. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  6124. @item luma_tmp
  6125. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  6126. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  6127. @item chroma_tmp
  6128. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  6129. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  6130. @end table
  6131. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  6132. @section hwupload_cuda
  6133. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  6134. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6135. @table @option
  6136. @item device
  6137. The number of the CUDA device to use
  6138. @end table
  6139. @section hqx
  6140. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  6141. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  6142. It accepts the following option:
  6143. @table @option
  6144. @item n
  6145. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  6146. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  6147. Default is @code{3}.
  6148. @end table
  6149. @section hstack
  6150. Stack input videos horizontally.
  6151. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  6152. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  6153. to create same output.
  6154. The filter accept the following option:
  6155. @table @option
  6156. @item inputs
  6157. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  6158. @item shortest
  6159. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  6160. terminates. Default value is 0.
  6161. @end table
  6162. @section hue
  6163. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  6164. It accepts the following parameters:
  6165. @table @option
  6166. @item h
  6167. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  6168. and defaults to "0".
  6169. @item s
  6170. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  6171. defaults to "1".
  6172. @item H
  6173. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  6174. expression, and defaults to "0".
  6175. @item b
  6176. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  6177. defaults to "0".
  6178. @end table
  6179. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  6180. specified at the same time.
  6181. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  6182. expressions containing the following constants:
  6183. @table @option
  6184. @item n
  6185. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  6186. @item pts
  6187. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  6188. @item r
  6189. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  6190. @item t
  6191. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  6192. @item tb
  6193. time base of the input video
  6194. @end table
  6195. @subsection Examples
  6196. @itemize
  6197. @item
  6198. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  6199. @example
  6200. hue=h=90:s=1
  6201. @end example
  6202. @item
  6203. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  6204. @example
  6205. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  6206. @end example
  6207. @item
  6208. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  6209. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  6210. @example
  6211. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  6212. @end example
  6213. @item
  6214. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  6215. @example
  6216. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  6217. @end example
  6218. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  6219. @example
  6220. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  6221. @end example
  6222. @item
  6223. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  6224. @example
  6225. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  6226. @end example
  6227. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  6228. @example
  6229. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  6230. @end example
  6231. @end itemize
  6232. @subsection Commands
  6233. This filter supports the following commands:
  6234. @table @option
  6235. @item b
  6236. @item s
  6237. @item h
  6238. @item H
  6239. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  6240. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6241. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6242. value.
  6243. @end table
  6244. @section idet
  6245. Detect video interlacing type.
  6246. This filter tries to detect if the input frames as interlaced, progressive,
  6247. top or bottom field first. It will also try and detect fields that are
  6248. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  6249. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  6250. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  6251. The filter will log these metadata values:
  6252. @table @option
  6253. @item single.current_frame
  6254. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  6255. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  6256. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  6257. @item single.tff
  6258. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  6259. @item multiple.tff
  6260. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  6261. @item single.bff
  6262. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  6263. @item multiple.current_frame
  6264. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  6265. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  6266. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  6267. @item multiple.bff
  6268. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  6269. @item single.progressive
  6270. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  6271. @item multiple.progressive
  6272. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  6273. @item single.undetermined
  6274. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  6275. @item multiple.undetermined
  6276. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  6277. @item repeated.current_frame
  6278. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  6279. @item repeated.neither
  6280. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  6281. @item repeated.top
  6282. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  6283. @item repeated.bottom
  6284. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  6285. @end table
  6286. The filter accepts the following options:
  6287. @table @option
  6288. @item intl_thres
  6289. Set interlacing threshold.
  6290. @item prog_thres
  6291. Set progressive threshold.
  6292. @item rep_thres
  6293. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  6294. @item half_life
  6295. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  6296. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to it's
  6297. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  6298. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  6299. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  6300. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  6301. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  6302. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  6303. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  6304. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  6305. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  6306. @end table
  6307. @section il
  6308. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  6309. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  6310. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  6311. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  6312. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  6313. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  6314. The filter accepts the following options:
  6315. @table @option
  6316. @item luma_mode, l
  6317. @item chroma_mode, c
  6318. @item alpha_mode, a
  6319. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  6320. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  6321. @table @samp
  6322. @item none
  6323. Do nothing.
  6324. @item deinterleave, d
  6325. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  6326. @item interleave, i
  6327. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  6328. @end table
  6329. Default value is @code{none}.
  6330. @item luma_swap, ls
  6331. @item chroma_swap, cs
  6332. @item alpha_swap, as
  6333. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  6334. @end table
  6335. @section inflate
  6336. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  6337. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6338. only values higher than the pixel.
  6339. It accepts the following options:
  6340. @table @option
  6341. @item threshold0
  6342. @item threshold1
  6343. @item threshold2
  6344. @item threshold3
  6345. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6346. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6347. @end table
  6348. @section interlace
  6349. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  6350. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  6351. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  6352. @example
  6353. Original Original New Frame
  6354. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  6355. ========== =========== ==================
  6356. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  6357. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  6358. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  6359. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  6360. ... ... ...
  6361. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  6362. @end example
  6363. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6364. @table @option
  6365. @item scan
  6366. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  6367. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  6368. @item lowpass
  6369. Enable (default) or disable the vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter
  6370. interlacing and reduce moire patterns.
  6371. @end table
  6372. @section kerndeint
  6373. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  6374. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  6375. progressive frames.
  6376. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  6377. @table @option
  6378. @item thresh
  6379. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  6380. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  6381. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  6382. applying the process on every pixels.
  6383. @item map
  6384. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  6385. Default is 0.
  6386. @item order
  6387. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  6388. 0. Default is 0.
  6389. @item sharp
  6390. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  6391. @item twoway
  6392. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  6393. @end table
  6394. @subsection Examples
  6395. @itemize
  6396. @item
  6397. Apply default values:
  6398. @example
  6399. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  6400. @end example
  6401. @item
  6402. Enable additional sharpening:
  6403. @example
  6404. kerndeint=sharp=1
  6405. @end example
  6406. @item
  6407. Paint processed pixels in white:
  6408. @example
  6409. kerndeint=map=1
  6410. @end example
  6411. @end itemize
  6412. @section lenscorrection
  6413. Correct radial lens distortion
  6414. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  6415. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  6416. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  6417. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  6418. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  6419. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  6420. Digikam from the KDE project.
  6421. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  6422. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  6423. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  6424. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  6425. be applied before or after lens correction.
  6426. @subsection Options
  6427. The filter accepts the following options:
  6428. @table @option
  6429. @item cx
  6430. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  6431. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  6432. width.
  6433. @item cy
  6434. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  6435. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  6436. height.
  6437. @item k1
  6438. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
  6439. @item k2
  6440. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
  6441. @end table
  6442. The formula that generates the correction is:
  6443. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  6444. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  6445. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  6446. @section loop, aloop
  6447. Loop video frames or audio samples.
  6448. Those filters accepts the following options:
  6449. @table @option
  6450. @item loop
  6451. Set the number of loops.
  6452. @item size
  6453. Set maximal size in number of frames for @code{loop} filter or maximal number
  6454. of samples in case of @code{aloop} filter.
  6455. @item start
  6456. Set first frame of loop for @code{loop} filter or first sample of loop in case
  6457. of @code{aloop} filter.
  6458. @end table
  6459. @anchor{lut3d}
  6460. @section lut3d
  6461. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  6462. The filter accepts the following options:
  6463. @table @option
  6464. @item file
  6465. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  6466. Currently supported formats:
  6467. @table @samp
  6468. @item 3dl
  6469. AfterEffects
  6470. @item cube
  6471. Iridas
  6472. @item dat
  6473. DaVinci
  6474. @item m3d
  6475. Pandora
  6476. @end table
  6477. @item interp
  6478. Select interpolation mode.
  6479. Available values are:
  6480. @table @samp
  6481. @item nearest
  6482. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  6483. @item trilinear
  6484. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  6485. @item tetrahedral
  6486. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  6487. @end table
  6488. @end table
  6489. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  6490. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  6491. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  6492. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  6493. to an RGB input video.
  6494. These filters accept the following parameters:
  6495. @table @option
  6496. @item c0
  6497. set first pixel component expression
  6498. @item c1
  6499. set second pixel component expression
  6500. @item c2
  6501. set third pixel component expression
  6502. @item c3
  6503. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  6504. @item r
  6505. set red component expression
  6506. @item g
  6507. set green component expression
  6508. @item b
  6509. set blue component expression
  6510. @item a
  6511. alpha component expression
  6512. @item y
  6513. set Y/luminance component expression
  6514. @item u
  6515. set U/Cb component expression
  6516. @item v
  6517. set V/Cr component expression
  6518. @end table
  6519. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  6520. the corresponding pixel component values.
  6521. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  6522. format in input.
  6523. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  6524. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  6525. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  6526. @table @option
  6527. @item w
  6528. @item h
  6529. The input width and height.
  6530. @item val
  6531. The input value for the pixel component.
  6532. @item clipval
  6533. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  6534. @item maxval
  6535. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  6536. @item minval
  6537. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  6538. @item negval
  6539. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  6540. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  6541. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  6542. @item clip(val)
  6543. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  6544. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  6545. @item gammaval(gamma)
  6546. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  6547. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  6548. expression
  6549. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  6550. @end table
  6551. All expressions default to "val".
  6552. @subsection Examples
  6553. @itemize
  6554. @item
  6555. Negate input video:
  6556. @example
  6557. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  6558. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  6559. @end example
  6560. The above is the same as:
  6561. @example
  6562. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  6563. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  6564. @end example
  6565. @item
  6566. Negate luminance:
  6567. @example
  6568. lutyuv=y=negval
  6569. @end example
  6570. @item
  6571. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  6572. @example
  6573. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  6574. @end example
  6575. @item
  6576. Apply a luma burning effect:
  6577. @example
  6578. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  6579. @end example
  6580. @item
  6581. Remove green and blue components:
  6582. @example
  6583. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  6584. @end example
  6585. @item
  6586. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  6587. @example
  6588. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  6589. @end example
  6590. @item
  6591. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  6592. @example
  6593. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  6594. @end example
  6595. @item
  6596. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  6597. @example
  6598. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  6599. @end example
  6600. @end itemize
  6601. @section maskedmerge
  6602. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  6603. weights in the third input stream.
  6604. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  6605. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  6606. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  6607. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  6608. input stream's pixel components.
  6609. This filter accepts the following options:
  6610. @table @option
  6611. @item planes
  6612. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  6613. copied from first stream.
  6614. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  6615. @end table
  6616. @section mcdeint
  6617. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  6618. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  6619. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  6620. This filter accepts the following options:
  6621. @table @option
  6622. @item mode
  6623. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  6624. It accepts one of the following values:
  6625. @table @samp
  6626. @item fast
  6627. @item medium
  6628. @item slow
  6629. use iterative motion estimation
  6630. @item extra_slow
  6631. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  6632. @end table
  6633. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  6634. @item parity
  6635. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  6636. one of the following values:
  6637. @table @samp
  6638. @item 0, tff
  6639. assume top field first
  6640. @item 1, bff
  6641. assume bottom field first
  6642. @end table
  6643. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  6644. @item qp
  6645. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  6646. encoder.
  6647. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  6648. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  6649. @end table
  6650. @section mergeplanes
  6651. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  6652. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  6653. planes to the output video.
  6654. This filter accepts the following options:
  6655. @table @option
  6656. @item mapping
  6657. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  6658. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  6659. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  6660. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  6661. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  6662. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  6663. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  6664. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  6665. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  6666. @item format
  6667. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  6668. @end table
  6669. @subsection Examples
  6670. @itemize
  6671. @item
  6672. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  6673. @example
  6674. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  6675. @end example
  6676. @item
  6677. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  6678. @example
  6679. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  6680. @end example
  6681. @item
  6682. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  6683. @example
  6684. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  6685. @end example
  6686. @item
  6687. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  6688. @example
  6689. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  6690. @end example
  6691. @item
  6692. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  6693. @example
  6694. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  6695. @end example
  6696. @end itemize
  6697. @section metadata, ametadata
  6698. Manipulate frame metadata.
  6699. This filter accepts the following options:
  6700. @table @option
  6701. @item mode
  6702. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  6703. Can be one of the following:
  6704. @table @samp
  6705. @item select
  6706. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  6707. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  6708. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  6709. @item add
  6710. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  6711. do nothing.
  6712. @item modify
  6713. Modify value of already present key.
  6714. @item delete
  6715. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  6716. Otherwise, delete key.
  6717. @item print
  6718. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  6719. metadata values available in frame.
  6720. @end table
  6721. @item key
  6722. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print}.
  6723. @item value
  6724. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  6725. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  6726. @item function
  6727. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  6728. Can be one of following:
  6729. @table @samp
  6730. @item same_str
  6731. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  6732. @item starts_with
  6733. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  6734. the @code{value} option string.
  6735. @item less
  6736. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  6737. @item equal
  6738. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  6739. @item greater
  6740. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  6741. @item expr
  6742. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  6743. evaluates to true.
  6744. @end table
  6745. @item expr
  6746. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  6747. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  6748. constants:
  6749. @table @option
  6750. @item VALUE1
  6751. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  6752. @item VALUE2
  6753. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  6754. @end table
  6755. @item file
  6756. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. When
  6757. filename equals "-" data is written to standard output.
  6758. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log with AV_LOG_INFO
  6759. loglevel.
  6760. @end table
  6761. @subsection Examples
  6762. @itemize
  6763. @item
  6764. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.singnalstats.YDIF} with values
  6765. between 0 and 1.
  6766. @example
  6767. @end example
  6768. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  6769. @end itemize
  6770. @section mpdecimate
  6771. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  6772. order to reduce frame rate.
  6773. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  6774. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  6775. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  6776. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6777. @table @option
  6778. @item max
  6779. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  6780. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  6781. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped unregarding the
  6782. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  6783. Default value is 0.
  6784. @item hi
  6785. @item lo
  6786. @item frac
  6787. Set the dropping threshold values.
  6788. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  6789. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  6790. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  6791. out differently over the block.
  6792. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  6793. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  6794. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  6795. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  6796. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  6797. @end table
  6798. @section negate
  6799. Negate input video.
  6800. It accepts an integer in input; if non-zero it negates the
  6801. alpha component (if available). The default value in input is 0.
  6802. @section nnedi
  6803. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  6804. This filter accepts the following options:
  6805. @table @option
  6806. @item weights
  6807. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  6808. Currently file can be found here:
  6809. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  6810. @item deint
  6811. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  6812. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  6813. @item field
  6814. Set mode of operation.
  6815. Can be one of the following:
  6816. @table @samp
  6817. @item af
  6818. Use frame flags, both fields.
  6819. @item a
  6820. Use frame flags, single field.
  6821. @item t
  6822. Use top field only.
  6823. @item b
  6824. Use bottom field only.
  6825. @item tf
  6826. Use both fields, top first.
  6827. @item bf
  6828. Use both fields, bottom first.
  6829. @end table
  6830. @item planes
  6831. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  6832. @item nsize
  6833. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  6834. network.
  6835. Can be one of the following:
  6836. @table @samp
  6837. @item s8x6
  6838. @item s16x6
  6839. @item s32x6
  6840. @item s48x6
  6841. @item s8x4
  6842. @item s16x4
  6843. @item s32x4
  6844. @end table
  6845. @item nns
  6846. Set the number of neurons in predicctor neural network.
  6847. Can be one of the following:
  6848. @table @samp
  6849. @item n16
  6850. @item n32
  6851. @item n64
  6852. @item n128
  6853. @item n256
  6854. @end table
  6855. @item qual
  6856. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  6857. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  6858. @code{slow}.
  6859. @item etype
  6860. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  6861. Can be one of the following:
  6862. @table @samp
  6863. @item a
  6864. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  6865. @item s
  6866. weights trained to minimize squared error
  6867. @end table
  6868. @item pscrn
  6869. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  6870. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  6871. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  6872. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  6873. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  6874. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  6875. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  6876. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  6877. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  6878. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  6879. Can be one of the following:
  6880. @table @samp
  6881. @item none
  6882. @item original
  6883. @item new
  6884. @end table
  6885. Default is @code{new}.
  6886. @item fapprox
  6887. Set various debugging flags.
  6888. @end table
  6889. @section noformat
  6890. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  6891. input to the next filter.
  6892. It accepts the following parameters:
  6893. @table @option
  6894. @item pix_fmts
  6895. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  6896. apix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  6897. @end table
  6898. @subsection Examples
  6899. @itemize
  6900. @item
  6901. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  6902. input to the vflip filter:
  6903. @example
  6904. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  6905. @end example
  6906. @item
  6907. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  6908. @example
  6909. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  6910. @end example
  6911. @end itemize
  6912. @section noise
  6913. Add noise on video input frame.
  6914. The filter accepts the following options:
  6915. @table @option
  6916. @item all_seed
  6917. @item c0_seed
  6918. @item c1_seed
  6919. @item c2_seed
  6920. @item c3_seed
  6921. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  6922. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  6923. @item all_strength, alls
  6924. @item c0_strength, c0s
  6925. @item c1_strength, c1s
  6926. @item c2_strength, c2s
  6927. @item c3_strength, c3s
  6928. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  6929. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  6930. @item all_flags, allf
  6931. @item c0_flags, c0f
  6932. @item c1_flags, c1f
  6933. @item c2_flags, c2f
  6934. @item c3_flags, c3f
  6935. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  6936. Available values for component flags are:
  6937. @table @samp
  6938. @item a
  6939. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  6940. @item p
  6941. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  6942. @item t
  6943. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  6944. @item u
  6945. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  6946. @end table
  6947. @end table
  6948. @subsection Examples
  6949. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  6950. @example
  6951. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  6952. @end example
  6953. @section null
  6954. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  6955. @section ocr
  6956. Optical Character Recognition
  6957. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition.
  6958. It accepts the following options:
  6959. @table @option
  6960. @item datapath
  6961. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  6962. set at installation.
  6963. @item language
  6964. Set language, default is "eng".
  6965. @item whitelist
  6966. Set character whitelist.
  6967. @item blacklist
  6968. Set character blacklist.
  6969. @end table
  6970. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  6971. @section ocv
  6972. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  6973. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  6974. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  6975. It accepts the following parameters:
  6976. @table @option
  6977. @item filter_name
  6978. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  6979. @item filter_params
  6980. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  6981. values are assumed.
  6982. @end table
  6983. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  6984. information:
  6985. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  6986. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  6987. @anchor{dilate}
  6988. @subsection dilate
  6989. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  6990. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  6991. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  6992. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  6993. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  6994. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  6995. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  6996. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  6997. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  6998. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  6999. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  7000. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  7001. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  7002. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  7003. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  7004. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  7005. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  7006. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  7007. Some examples:
  7008. @example
  7009. # Use the default values
  7010. ocv=dilate
  7011. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  7012. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  7013. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  7014. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  7015. # *
  7016. # ***
  7017. # *****
  7018. # ***
  7019. # *
  7020. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  7021. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  7022. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  7023. @end example
  7024. @subsection erode
  7025. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  7026. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  7027. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  7028. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  7029. @subsection smooth
  7030. Smooth the input video.
  7031. The filter takes the following parameters:
  7032. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  7033. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  7034. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  7035. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  7036. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  7037. depend on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  7038. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  7039. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  7040. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  7041. other parameters is 0.
  7042. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  7043. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  7044. @anchor{overlay}
  7045. @section overlay
  7046. Overlay one video on top of another.
  7047. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  7048. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  7049. It accepts the following parameters:
  7050. A description of the accepted options follows.
  7051. @table @option
  7052. @item x
  7053. @item y
  7054. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  7055. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  7056. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  7057. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  7058. @item eof_action
  7059. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  7060. one of the following values:
  7061. @table @option
  7062. @item repeat
  7063. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  7064. @item endall
  7065. End both streams.
  7066. @item pass
  7067. Pass the main input through.
  7068. @end table
  7069. @item eval
  7070. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  7071. It accepts the following values:
  7072. @table @samp
  7073. @item init
  7074. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7075. when a command is processed
  7076. @item frame
  7077. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7078. @end table
  7079. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  7080. @item shortest
  7081. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  7082. terminates. Default value is 0.
  7083. @item format
  7084. Set the format for the output video.
  7085. It accepts the following values:
  7086. @table @samp
  7087. @item yuv420
  7088. force YUV420 output
  7089. @item yuv422
  7090. force YUV422 output
  7091. @item yuv444
  7092. force YUV444 output
  7093. @item rgb
  7094. force RGB output
  7095. @end table
  7096. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  7097. @item rgb @emph{(deprecated)}
  7098. If set to 1, force the filter to accept inputs in the RGB
  7099. color space. Default value is 0. This option is deprecated, use
  7100. @option{format} instead.
  7101. @item repeatlast
  7102. If set to 1, force the filter to draw the last overlay frame over the
  7103. main input until the end of the stream. A value of 0 disables this
  7104. behavior. Default value is 1.
  7105. @end table
  7106. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  7107. parameters.
  7108. @table @option
  7109. @item main_w, W
  7110. @item main_h, H
  7111. The main input width and height.
  7112. @item overlay_w, w
  7113. @item overlay_h, h
  7114. The overlay input width and height.
  7115. @item x
  7116. @item y
  7117. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  7118. each new frame.
  7119. @item hsub
  7120. @item vsub
  7121. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  7122. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  7123. @var{vsub} is 1.
  7124. @item n
  7125. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7126. @item pos
  7127. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  7128. @item t
  7129. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  7130. @end table
  7131. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  7132. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  7133. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  7134. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  7135. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  7136. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  7137. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  7138. the @var{movie} filter does.
  7139. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  7140. efficiency of such approach.
  7141. @subsection Commands
  7142. This filter supports the following commands:
  7143. @table @option
  7144. @item x
  7145. @item y
  7146. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  7147. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7148. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7149. value.
  7150. @end table
  7151. @subsection Examples
  7152. @itemize
  7153. @item
  7154. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  7155. video:
  7156. @example
  7157. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  7158. @end example
  7159. Using named options the example above becomes:
  7160. @example
  7161. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  7162. @end example
  7163. @item
  7164. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  7165. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  7166. @example
  7167. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  7168. @end example
  7169. @item
  7170. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  7171. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  7172. @example
  7173. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  7174. @end example
  7175. @item
  7176. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  7177. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  7178. @example
  7179. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  7180. @end example
  7181. @item
  7182. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  7183. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  7184. @example
  7185. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  7186. @end example
  7187. The above command is the same as:
  7188. @example
  7189. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  7190. @end example
  7191. @item
  7192. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  7193. screen starting since time 2:
  7194. @example
  7195. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  7196. @end example
  7197. @item
  7198. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  7199. @example
  7200. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  7201. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  7202. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  7203. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  7204. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  7205. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  7206. "
  7207. @end example
  7208. @item
  7209. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  7210. @example
  7211. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  7212. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  7213. masked.avi
  7214. @end example
  7215. @item
  7216. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  7217. @example
  7218. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  7219. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  7220. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  7221. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  7222. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  7223. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  7224. @end example
  7225. @end itemize
  7226. @section owdenoise
  7227. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  7228. The filter accepts the following options:
  7229. @table @option
  7230. @item depth
  7231. Set depth.
  7232. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  7233. slow down filtering.
  7234. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  7235. @item luma_strength, ls
  7236. Set luma strength.
  7237. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  7238. @item chroma_strength, cs
  7239. Set chroma strength.
  7240. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  7241. @end table
  7242. @anchor{pad}
  7243. @section pad
  7244. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  7245. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  7246. It accepts the following parameters:
  7247. @table @option
  7248. @item width, w
  7249. @item height, h
  7250. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  7251. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  7252. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  7253. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  7254. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  7255. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  7256. @item x
  7257. @item y
  7258. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  7259. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  7260. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  7261. expression, and vice versa.
  7262. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  7263. @item color
  7264. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  7265. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  7266. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  7267. @end table
  7268. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  7269. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  7270. @table @option
  7271. @item in_w
  7272. @item in_h
  7273. The input video width and height.
  7274. @item iw
  7275. @item ih
  7276. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  7277. @item out_w
  7278. @item out_h
  7279. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  7280. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  7281. @item ow
  7282. @item oh
  7283. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  7284. @item x
  7285. @item y
  7286. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  7287. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  7288. @item a
  7289. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  7290. @item sar
  7291. input sample aspect ratio
  7292. @item dar
  7293. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  7294. @item hsub
  7295. @item vsub
  7296. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7297. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7298. @end table
  7299. @subsection Examples
  7300. @itemize
  7301. @item
  7302. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  7303. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  7304. column 0, row 40
  7305. @example
  7306. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  7307. @end example
  7308. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  7309. @example
  7310. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  7311. @end example
  7312. @item
  7313. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  7314. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  7315. @example
  7316. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7317. @end example
  7318. @item
  7319. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  7320. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  7321. the center of the padded area:
  7322. @example
  7323. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7324. @end example
  7325. @item
  7326. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  7327. @example
  7328. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7329. @end example
  7330. @item
  7331. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  7332. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  7333. according to the relation:
  7334. @example
  7335. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  7336. X = output_dar / sar
  7337. @end example
  7338. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  7339. @example
  7340. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7341. @end example
  7342. @item
  7343. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  7344. corner of the output padded area:
  7345. @example
  7346. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  7347. @end example
  7348. @end itemize
  7349. @anchor{palettegen}
  7350. @section palettegen
  7351. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  7352. It accepts the following options:
  7353. @table @option
  7354. @item max_colors
  7355. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  7356. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  7357. will be black.
  7358. @item reserve_transparent
  7359. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  7360. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  7361. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  7362. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  7363. Set by default.
  7364. @item stats_mode
  7365. Set statistics mode.
  7366. It accepts the following values:
  7367. @table @samp
  7368. @item full
  7369. Compute full frame histograms.
  7370. @item diff
  7371. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  7372. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  7373. the background is static.
  7374. @end table
  7375. Default value is @var{full}.
  7376. @end table
  7377. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  7378. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  7379. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  7380. @var{info} logging level.
  7381. @subsection Examples
  7382. @itemize
  7383. @item
  7384. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  7385. @example
  7386. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  7387. @end example
  7388. @end itemize
  7389. @section paletteuse
  7390. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  7391. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  7392. be a 256 pixels image.
  7393. It accepts the following options:
  7394. @table @option
  7395. @item dither
  7396. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  7397. @table @samp
  7398. @item bayer
  7399. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  7400. @item heckbert
  7401. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  7402. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  7403. reference.
  7404. @item floyd_steinberg
  7405. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  7406. @item sierra2
  7407. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  7408. @item sierra2_4a
  7409. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  7410. @end table
  7411. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  7412. @item bayer_scale
  7413. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  7414. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  7415. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  7416. at the cost of more banding.
  7417. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  7418. @item diff_mode
  7419. If set, define the zone to process
  7420. @table @samp
  7421. @item rectangle
  7422. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  7423. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  7424. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  7425. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  7426. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  7427. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  7428. @end table
  7429. Default is @var{none}.
  7430. @end table
  7431. @subsection Examples
  7432. @itemize
  7433. @item
  7434. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  7435. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  7436. @example
  7437. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  7438. @end example
  7439. @end itemize
  7440. @section perspective
  7441. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  7442. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  7443. @table @option
  7444. @item x0
  7445. @item y0
  7446. @item x1
  7447. @item y1
  7448. @item x2
  7449. @item y2
  7450. @item x3
  7451. @item y3
  7452. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  7453. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  7454. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  7455. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  7456. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  7457. The expressions can use the following variables:
  7458. @table @option
  7459. @item W
  7460. @item H
  7461. the width and height of video frame.
  7462. @end table
  7463. @item interpolation
  7464. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  7465. It accepts the following values:
  7466. @table @samp
  7467. @item linear
  7468. @item cubic
  7469. @end table
  7470. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  7471. @item sense
  7472. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  7473. It accepts the following values:
  7474. @table @samp
  7475. @item 0, source
  7476. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  7477. the corners of the destination.
  7478. @item 1, destination
  7479. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  7480. by the given coordinates.
  7481. Default value is @samp{source}.
  7482. @end table
  7483. @end table
  7484. @section phase
  7485. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  7486. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  7487. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  7488. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  7489. @table @option
  7490. @item mode
  7491. Set phase mode.
  7492. It accepts the following values:
  7493. @table @samp
  7494. @item t
  7495. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  7496. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  7497. @item b
  7498. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  7499. Filter will delay the top field.
  7500. @item p
  7501. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  7502. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  7503. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  7504. @item a
  7505. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  7506. opposite.
  7507. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  7508. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  7509. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  7510. @item u
  7511. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  7512. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  7513. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  7514. match between the fields.
  7515. @item T
  7516. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  7517. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  7518. @item B
  7519. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  7520. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  7521. @item A
  7522. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  7523. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  7524. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  7525. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  7526. @item U
  7527. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  7528. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  7529. @end table
  7530. @end table
  7531. @section pixdesctest
  7532. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  7533. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  7534. For example:
  7535. @example
  7536. format=monow, pixdesctest
  7537. @end example
  7538. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  7539. @section pp
  7540. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  7541. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  7542. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  7543. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  7544. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  7545. The filters accept the following options:
  7546. @table @option
  7547. @item subfilters
  7548. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  7549. @end table
  7550. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  7551. @table @option
  7552. @item a/autoq
  7553. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  7554. @item c/chrom
  7555. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  7556. @item y/nochrom
  7557. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  7558. @item n/noluma
  7559. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  7560. @end table
  7561. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  7562. Available subfilters are:
  7563. @table @option
  7564. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  7565. Horizontal deblocking filter
  7566. @table @option
  7567. @item difference
  7568. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  7569. @item flatness
  7570. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  7571. @end table
  7572. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  7573. Vertical deblocking filter
  7574. @table @option
  7575. @item difference
  7576. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  7577. @item flatness
  7578. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  7579. @end table
  7580. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  7581. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  7582. @table @option
  7583. @item difference
  7584. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  7585. @item flatness
  7586. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  7587. @end table
  7588. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  7589. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  7590. @table @option
  7591. @item difference
  7592. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  7593. @item flatness
  7594. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  7595. @end table
  7596. @end table
  7597. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  7598. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  7599. thresholds.
  7600. @table @option
  7601. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  7602. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  7603. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  7604. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  7605. @item dr/dering
  7606. Deringing filter
  7607. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  7608. @table @option
  7609. @item threshold1
  7610. larger -> stronger filtering
  7611. @item threshold2
  7612. larger -> stronger filtering
  7613. @item threshold3
  7614. larger -> stronger filtering
  7615. @end table
  7616. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  7617. @table @option
  7618. @item f/fullyrange
  7619. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  7620. @end table
  7621. @item lb/linblenddeint
  7622. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  7623. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  7624. @item li/linipoldeint
  7625. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  7626. linearly interpolating every second line.
  7627. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  7628. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  7629. cubically interpolating every second line.
  7630. @item md/mediandeint
  7631. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  7632. median filter to every second line.
  7633. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  7634. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  7635. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  7636. @item l5/lowpass5
  7637. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  7638. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  7639. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  7640. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  7641. specify.
  7642. @table @option
  7643. @item quantizer
  7644. Quantizer to use
  7645. @end table
  7646. @item de/default
  7647. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  7648. @item fa/fast
  7649. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  7650. @item ac
  7651. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  7652. @end table
  7653. @subsection Examples
  7654. @itemize
  7655. @item
  7656. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  7657. brightness/contrast:
  7658. @example
  7659. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  7660. @end example
  7661. @item
  7662. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  7663. @example
  7664. pp=de/-al
  7665. @end example
  7666. @item
  7667. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  7668. @example
  7669. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  7670. @end example
  7671. @item
  7672. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  7673. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  7674. @example
  7675. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  7676. @end example
  7677. @end itemize
  7678. @section pp7
  7679. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  7680. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  7681. used after IDCT.
  7682. The filter accepts the following options:
  7683. @table @option
  7684. @item qp
  7685. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  7686. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  7687. (if available).
  7688. @item mode
  7689. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  7690. @table @samp
  7691. @item hard
  7692. Set hard thresholding.
  7693. @item soft
  7694. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  7695. @item medium
  7696. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  7697. @end table
  7698. @end table
  7699. @section psnr
  7700. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  7701. Ratio) between two input videos.
  7702. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  7703. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  7704. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  7705. the PSNR.
  7706. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  7707. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  7708. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  7709. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  7710. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  7711. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  7712. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  7713. @example
  7714. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  7715. @end example
  7716. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  7717. image.
  7718. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  7719. @table @option
  7720. @item stats_file, f
  7721. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  7722. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  7723. standard output.
  7724. @end table
  7725. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  7726. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  7727. couple of frames.
  7728. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  7729. @table @option
  7730. @item n
  7731. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  7732. @item mse_avg
  7733. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  7734. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  7735. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_g, mse_a
  7736. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  7737. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  7738. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  7739. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  7740. specified by the suffix.
  7741. @end table
  7742. For example:
  7743. @example
  7744. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  7745. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  7746. @end example
  7747. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  7748. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  7749. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  7750. @anchor{pullup}
  7751. @section pullup
  7752. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  7753. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  7754. content.
  7755. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  7756. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  7757. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  7758. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  7759. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  7760. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  7761. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  7762. The filter accepts the following options:
  7763. @table @option
  7764. @item jl
  7765. @item jr
  7766. @item jt
  7767. @item jb
  7768. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  7769. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  7770. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  7771. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  7772. @item sb
  7773. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  7774. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  7775. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  7776. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  7777. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  7778. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  7779. Default value is @code{0}.
  7780. @item mp
  7781. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  7782. @table @samp
  7783. @item l
  7784. Use luma plane.
  7785. @item u
  7786. Use chroma blue plane.
  7787. @item v
  7788. Use chroma red plane.
  7789. @end table
  7790. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  7791. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  7792. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  7793. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  7794. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  7795. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  7796. @end table
  7797. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  7798. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  7799. telecine NTSC input:
  7800. @example
  7801. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  7802. @end example
  7803. @section qp
  7804. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  7805. The filter accepts the following option:
  7806. @table @option
  7807. @item qp
  7808. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  7809. @end table
  7810. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  7811. the following constants:
  7812. @table @var
  7813. @item known
  7814. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  7815. @item qp
  7816. Sequentional index starting from -129 to 128.
  7817. @end table
  7818. @subsection Examples
  7819. @itemize
  7820. @item
  7821. Some equation like:
  7822. @example
  7823. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  7824. @end example
  7825. @end itemize
  7826. @section random
  7827. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  7828. No frame is discarded.
  7829. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  7830. @table @option
  7831. @item frames
  7832. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  7833. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  7834. @item seed
  7835. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  7836. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  7837. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  7838. best effort basis.
  7839. @end table
  7840. @section removegrain
  7841. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  7842. @table @option
  7843. @item m0
  7844. Set mode for the first plane.
  7845. @item m1
  7846. Set mode for the second plane.
  7847. @item m2
  7848. Set mode for the third plane.
  7849. @item m3
  7850. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  7851. @end table
  7852. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  7853. @table @var
  7854. @item 0
  7855. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  7856. @item 1
  7857. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  7858. @item 2
  7859. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  7860. @item 3
  7861. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  7862. @item 4
  7863. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  7864. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  7865. @item 5
  7866. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  7867. @item 6
  7868. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  7869. @item 7
  7870. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  7871. @item 8
  7872. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  7873. @item 9
  7874. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  7875. @item 10
  7876. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  7877. @item 11
  7878. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  7879. @item 12
  7880. Same as mode 11.
  7881. @item 13
  7882. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  7883. pixels are the closest.
  7884. @item 14
  7885. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  7886. pixels are the closest.
  7887. @item 15
  7888. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  7889. interpolation formula.
  7890. @item 16
  7891. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  7892. interpolation formula.
  7893. @item 17
  7894. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  7895. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  7896. @item 18
  7897. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  7898. the current pixel is minimal.
  7899. @item 19
  7900. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  7901. @item 20
  7902. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  7903. @item 21
  7904. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  7905. @item 22
  7906. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  7907. @item 23
  7908. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  7909. @item 24
  7910. Similar as 23.
  7911. @end table
  7912. @section removelogo
  7913. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  7914. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  7915. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  7916. The filter accepts the following options:
  7917. @table @option
  7918. @item filename, f
  7919. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  7920. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  7921. video stream being processed.
  7922. @end table
  7923. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  7924. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  7925. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  7926. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  7927. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  7928. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  7929. filter once or twice.
  7930. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  7931. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  7932. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  7933. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  7934. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  7935. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  7936. @section repeatfields
  7937. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  7938. fields based on its value.
  7939. @section reverse, areverse
  7940. Reverse a clip.
  7941. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  7942. is suggested.
  7943. @subsection Examples
  7944. @itemize
  7945. @item
  7946. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  7947. @example
  7948. trim=end=5,reverse
  7949. @end example
  7950. @end itemize
  7951. @section rotate
  7952. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  7953. The filter accepts the following options:
  7954. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  7955. @table @option
  7956. @item angle, a
  7957. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  7958. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  7959. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  7960. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  7961. @item out_w, ow
  7962. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  7963. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  7964. @item out_h, oh
  7965. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  7966. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  7967. @item bilinear
  7968. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  7969. it. Default value is 1.
  7970. @item fillcolor, c
  7971. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  7972. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
  7973. ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  7974. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  7975. Default value is "black".
  7976. @end table
  7977. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  7978. following constants and functions:
  7979. @table @option
  7980. @item n
  7981. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  7982. before the first frame is filtered.
  7983. @item t
  7984. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  7985. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  7986. @item hsub
  7987. @item vsub
  7988. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7989. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7990. @item in_w, iw
  7991. @item in_h, ih
  7992. the input video width and height
  7993. @item out_w, ow
  7994. @item out_h, oh
  7995. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  7996. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  7997. @item rotw(a)
  7998. @item roth(a)
  7999. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  8000. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  8001. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  8002. @option{out_h} expressions.
  8003. @end table
  8004. @subsection Examples
  8005. @itemize
  8006. @item
  8007. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  8008. @example
  8009. rotate=PI/6
  8010. @end example
  8011. @item
  8012. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  8013. @example
  8014. rotate=-PI/6
  8015. @end example
  8016. @item
  8017. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  8018. @example
  8019. rotate=45*PI/180
  8020. @end example
  8021. @item
  8022. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  8023. @example
  8024. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  8025. @end example
  8026. @item
  8027. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  8028. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  8029. @example
  8030. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  8031. @end example
  8032. @item
  8033. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  8034. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  8035. @example
  8036. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  8037. @end example
  8038. @item
  8039. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  8040. shown:
  8041. @example
  8042. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  8043. @end example
  8044. @end itemize
  8045. @subsection Commands
  8046. The filter supports the following commands:
  8047. @table @option
  8048. @item a, angle
  8049. Set the angle expression.
  8050. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8051. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8052. value.
  8053. @end table
  8054. @section sab
  8055. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  8056. The filter accepts the following options:
  8057. @table @option
  8058. @item luma_radius, lr
  8059. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  8060. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  8061. in slower processing.
  8062. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  8063. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  8064. value is 1.0.
  8065. @item luma_strength, ls
  8066. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  8067. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  8068. @item chroma_radius, cr
  8069. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0. A
  8070. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  8071. processing.
  8072. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  8073. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range.
  8074. @item chroma_strength, cs
  8075. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  8076. must be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range.
  8077. @end table
  8078. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  8079. corresponding luma option value.
  8080. @anchor{scale}
  8081. @section scale
  8082. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  8083. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  8084. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  8085. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  8086. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  8087. requested format.
  8088. @subsection Options
  8089. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  8090. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  8091. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  8092. the complete list of scaler options.
  8093. @table @option
  8094. @item width, w
  8095. @item height, h
  8096. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  8097. dimension.
  8098. If the value is 0, the input width is used for the output.
  8099. If one of the values is -1, the scale filter will use a value that
  8100. maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
  8101. other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
  8102. used
  8103. If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the scale filter will also use a value
  8104. that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
  8105. specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
  8106. dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
  8107. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  8108. expression.
  8109. @item eval
  8110. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  8111. @table @samp
  8112. @item init
  8113. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  8114. @item frame
  8115. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  8116. @end table
  8117. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8118. @item interl
  8119. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  8120. @table @samp
  8121. @item 1
  8122. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  8123. @item 0
  8124. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  8125. @item -1
  8126. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  8127. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  8128. @end table
  8129. Default value is @samp{0}.
  8130. @item flags
  8131. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  8132. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  8133. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  8134. the default flags.
  8135. @item param0, param1
  8136. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  8137. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  8138. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  8139. empty parameters.
  8140. @item size, s
  8141. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  8142. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  8143. @item in_color_matrix
  8144. @item out_color_matrix
  8145. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  8146. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  8147. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  8148. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  8149. Possible values:
  8150. @table @samp
  8151. @item auto
  8152. Choose automatically.
  8153. @item bt709
  8154. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  8155. Recommendation BT.709.
  8156. @item fcc
  8157. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  8158. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  8159. @item bt601
  8160. Set color space conforming to:
  8161. @itemize
  8162. @item
  8163. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  8164. @item
  8165. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  8166. @item
  8167. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  8168. @end itemize
  8169. @item smpte240m
  8170. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  8171. @end table
  8172. @item in_range
  8173. @item out_range
  8174. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  8175. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  8176. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  8177. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  8178. @table @samp
  8179. @item auto
  8180. Choose automatically.
  8181. @item jpeg/full/pc
  8182. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  8183. @item mpeg/tv
  8184. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  8185. @end table
  8186. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  8187. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  8188. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  8189. @table @samp
  8190. @item disable
  8191. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  8192. @item decrease
  8193. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  8194. @item increase
  8195. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  8196. @end table
  8197. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  8198. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  8199. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  8200. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  8201. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  8202. 1280x533.
  8203. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  8204. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  8205. to work.
  8206. @end table
  8207. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  8208. containing the following constants:
  8209. @table @var
  8210. @item in_w
  8211. @item in_h
  8212. The input width and height
  8213. @item iw
  8214. @item ih
  8215. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  8216. @item out_w
  8217. @item out_h
  8218. The output (scaled) width and height
  8219. @item ow
  8220. @item oh
  8221. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  8222. @item a
  8223. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  8224. @item sar
  8225. input sample aspect ratio
  8226. @item dar
  8227. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  8228. @item hsub
  8229. @item vsub
  8230. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8231. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8232. @item ohsub
  8233. @item ovsub
  8234. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8235. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8236. @end table
  8237. @subsection Examples
  8238. @itemize
  8239. @item
  8240. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  8241. @example
  8242. scale=w=200:h=100
  8243. @end example
  8244. This is equivalent to:
  8245. @example
  8246. scale=200:100
  8247. @end example
  8248. or:
  8249. @example
  8250. scale=200x100
  8251. @end example
  8252. @item
  8253. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  8254. @example
  8255. scale=qcif
  8256. @end example
  8257. which can also be written as:
  8258. @example
  8259. scale=size=qcif
  8260. @end example
  8261. @item
  8262. Scale the input to 2x:
  8263. @example
  8264. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  8265. @end example
  8266. @item
  8267. The above is the same as:
  8268. @example
  8269. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  8270. @end example
  8271. @item
  8272. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  8273. @example
  8274. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  8275. @end example
  8276. @item
  8277. Scale the input to half size:
  8278. @example
  8279. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  8280. @end example
  8281. @item
  8282. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  8283. @example
  8284. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  8285. @end example
  8286. @item
  8287. Seek Greek harmony:
  8288. @example
  8289. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  8290. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  8291. @end example
  8292. @item
  8293. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  8294. @example
  8295. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  8296. @end example
  8297. @item
  8298. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  8299. subsample values:
  8300. @example
  8301. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  8302. @end example
  8303. @item
  8304. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  8305. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  8306. @example
  8307. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  8308. @end example
  8309. @end itemize
  8310. @subsection Commands
  8311. This filter supports the following commands:
  8312. @table @option
  8313. @item width, w
  8314. @item height, h
  8315. Set the output video dimension expression.
  8316. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8317. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8318. value.
  8319. @end table
  8320. @section scale2ref
  8321. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  8322. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  8323. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis.
  8324. @subsection Examples
  8325. @itemize
  8326. @item
  8327. Scale a subtitle stream to match the main video in size before overlaying
  8328. @example
  8329. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  8330. @end example
  8331. @end itemize
  8332. @section selectivecolor
  8333. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  8334. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  8335. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  8336. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  8337. The filter accepts the following options:
  8338. @table @option
  8339. @item correction_method
  8340. Select color correction method.
  8341. Available values are:
  8342. @table @samp
  8343. @item absolute
  8344. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  8345. component value).
  8346. @item relative
  8347. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  8348. @end table
  8349. Default is @code{absolute}.
  8350. @item reds
  8351. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  8352. @item yellows
  8353. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  8354. @item greens
  8355. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  8356. @item cyans
  8357. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  8358. @item blues
  8359. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  8360. @item magentas
  8361. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  8362. @item whites
  8363. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  8364. @item neutrals
  8365. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  8366. @item blacks
  8367. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  8368. @item psfile
  8369. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  8370. @end table
  8371. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  8372. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  8373. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  8374. pixels of its range.
  8375. @subsection Examples
  8376. @itemize
  8377. @item
  8378. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  8379. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  8380. @example
  8381. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  8382. @end example
  8383. @item
  8384. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  8385. @example
  8386. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  8387. @end example
  8388. @end itemize
  8389. @section separatefields
  8390. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  8391. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  8392. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  8393. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  8394. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  8395. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  8396. @section setdar, setsar
  8397. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  8398. output video.
  8399. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  8400. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  8401. @example
  8402. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  8403. @end example
  8404. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  8405. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  8406. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  8407. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  8408. applied.
  8409. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  8410. the filter output video.
  8411. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  8412. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  8413. above.
  8414. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  8415. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  8416. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  8417. It accepts the following parameters:
  8418. @table @option
  8419. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  8420. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  8421. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  8422. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  8423. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  8424. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  8425. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  8426. should be escaped.
  8427. @item max
  8428. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  8429. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  8430. Default value is @code{100}.
  8431. @end table
  8432. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  8433. the following constants:
  8434. @table @option
  8435. @item E, PI, PHI
  8436. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  8437. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  8438. @item w, h
  8439. The input width and height.
  8440. @item a
  8441. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  8442. @item sar
  8443. The input sample aspect ratio.
  8444. @item dar
  8445. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  8446. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  8447. @item hsub, vsub
  8448. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  8449. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8450. @end table
  8451. @subsection Examples
  8452. @itemize
  8453. @item
  8454. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  8455. @example
  8456. setdar=dar=1.77777
  8457. setdar=dar=16/9
  8458. setdar=dar=1.77777
  8459. @end example
  8460. @item
  8461. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  8462. @example
  8463. setsar=sar=10/11
  8464. @end example
  8465. @item
  8466. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  8467. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  8468. @example
  8469. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  8470. @end example
  8471. @end itemize
  8472. @anchor{setfield}
  8473. @section setfield
  8474. Force field for the output video frame.
  8475. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  8476. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  8477. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  8478. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  8479. The filter accepts the following options:
  8480. @table @option
  8481. @item mode
  8482. Available values are:
  8483. @table @samp
  8484. @item auto
  8485. Keep the same field property.
  8486. @item bff
  8487. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  8488. @item tff
  8489. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  8490. @item prog
  8491. Mark the frame as progressive.
  8492. @end table
  8493. @end table
  8494. @section showinfo
  8495. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  8496. The input video is not modified.
  8497. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  8498. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  8499. The following values are shown in the output:
  8500. @table @option
  8501. @item n
  8502. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  8503. @item pts
  8504. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  8505. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  8506. @item pts_time
  8507. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  8508. seconds.
  8509. @item pos
  8510. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  8511. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  8512. @item fmt
  8513. The pixel format name.
  8514. @item sar
  8515. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  8516. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  8517. @item s
  8518. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  8519. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  8520. @item i
  8521. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  8522. for bottom field first).
  8523. @item iskey
  8524. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  8525. @item type
  8526. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  8527. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  8528. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  8529. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  8530. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  8531. @item checksum
  8532. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  8533. @item plane_checksum
  8534. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  8535. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  8536. @end table
  8537. @section showpalette
  8538. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  8539. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  8540. It accepts the following option:
  8541. @table @option
  8542. @item s
  8543. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  8544. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  8545. @end table
  8546. @section shuffleframes
  8547. Reorder and/or duplicate video frames.
  8548. It accepts the following parameters:
  8549. @table @option
  8550. @item mapping
  8551. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  8552. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  8553. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  8554. @end table
  8555. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  8556. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  8557. @example
  8558. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  8559. @end example
  8560. @section shuffleplanes
  8561. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  8562. It accepts the following parameters:
  8563. @table @option
  8564. @item map0
  8565. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  8566. @item map1
  8567. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  8568. @item map2
  8569. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  8570. @item map3
  8571. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  8572. @end table
  8573. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  8574. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  8575. @example
  8576. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  8577. @end example
  8578. @anchor{signalstats}
  8579. @section signalstats
  8580. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  8581. with the digitization of analog video media.
  8582. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  8583. @table @option
  8584. @item YMIN
  8585. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  8586. range of [0-255].
  8587. @item YLOW
  8588. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  8589. range of [0-255].
  8590. @item YAVG
  8591. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  8592. [0-255].
  8593. @item YHIGH
  8594. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  8595. range of [0-255].
  8596. @item YMAX
  8597. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  8598. range of [0-255].
  8599. @item UMIN
  8600. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  8601. range of [0-255].
  8602. @item ULOW
  8603. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  8604. range of [0-255].
  8605. @item UAVG
  8606. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  8607. [0-255].
  8608. @item UHIGH
  8609. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  8610. range of [0-255].
  8611. @item UMAX
  8612. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  8613. range of [0-255].
  8614. @item VMIN
  8615. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  8616. range of [0-255].
  8617. @item VLOW
  8618. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  8619. range of [0-255].
  8620. @item VAVG
  8621. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  8622. [0-255].
  8623. @item VHIGH
  8624. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  8625. range of [0-255].
  8626. @item VMAX
  8627. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  8628. range of [0-255].
  8629. @item SATMIN
  8630. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  8631. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  8632. @item SATLOW
  8633. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  8634. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  8635. @item SATAVG
  8636. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  8637. of [0-~181.02].
  8638. @item SATHIGH
  8639. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  8640. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  8641. @item SATMAX
  8642. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  8643. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  8644. @item HUEMED
  8645. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  8646. [0-360].
  8647. @item HUEAVG
  8648. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  8649. [0-360].
  8650. @item YDIF
  8651. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  8652. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  8653. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  8654. @item UDIF
  8655. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  8656. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  8657. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  8658. @item VDIF
  8659. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  8660. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  8661. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  8662. @end table
  8663. The filter accepts the following options:
  8664. @table @option
  8665. @item stat
  8666. @item out
  8667. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  8668. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  8669. Both options accept the following values:
  8670. @table @samp
  8671. @item tout
  8672. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  8673. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  8674. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  8675. @item vrep
  8676. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  8677. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  8678. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  8679. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  8680. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  8681. @item brng
  8682. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  8683. @end table
  8684. @item color, c
  8685. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  8686. yellow.
  8687. @end table
  8688. @subsection Examples
  8689. @itemize
  8690. @item
  8691. Output data of various video metrics:
  8692. @example
  8693. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  8694. @end example
  8695. @item
  8696. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  8697. @example
  8698. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  8699. @end example
  8700. @item
  8701. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  8702. @example
  8703. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  8704. @end example
  8705. @item
  8706. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  8707. @example
  8708. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  8709. @end example
  8710. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  8711. @example
  8712. time %@{pts:hms@}
  8713. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  8714. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  8715. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  8716. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  8717. @end example
  8718. @end itemize
  8719. @anchor{smartblur}
  8720. @section smartblur
  8721. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  8722. It accepts the following options:
  8723. @table @option
  8724. @item luma_radius, lr
  8725. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  8726. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  8727. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  8728. @item luma_strength, ls
  8729. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  8730. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  8731. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  8732. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  8733. @item luma_threshold, lt
  8734. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  8735. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  8736. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  8737. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  8738. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  8739. @item chroma_radius, cr
  8740. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  8741. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  8742. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  8743. @item chroma_strength, cs
  8744. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  8745. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  8746. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  8747. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  8748. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  8749. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  8750. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  8751. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  8752. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  8753. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  8754. @end table
  8755. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  8756. is set.
  8757. @section ssim
  8758. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  8759. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  8760. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  8761. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  8762. the SSIM.
  8763. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  8764. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  8765. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  8766. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  8767. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  8768. @table @option
  8769. @item stats_file, f
  8770. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  8771. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  8772. standard output.
  8773. @end table
  8774. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  8775. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  8776. couple of frames.
  8777. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  8778. @table @option
  8779. @item n
  8780. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  8781. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  8782. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  8783. @item All
  8784. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  8785. @item dB
  8786. Same as above but in dB representation.
  8787. @end table
  8788. For example:
  8789. @example
  8790. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  8791. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  8792. @end example
  8793. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  8794. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  8795. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  8796. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  8797. @example
  8798. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  8799. @end example
  8800. @section stereo3d
  8801. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  8802. The filters accept the following options:
  8803. @table @option
  8804. @item in
  8805. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  8806. Available values for input image formats are:
  8807. @table @samp
  8808. @item sbsl
  8809. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  8810. @item sbsr
  8811. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  8812. @item sbs2l
  8813. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  8814. (left eye left, right eye right)
  8815. @item sbs2r
  8816. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  8817. (right eye left, left eye right)
  8818. @item abl
  8819. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  8820. @item abr
  8821. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  8822. @item ab2l
  8823. above-below with half height resolution
  8824. (left eye above, right eye below)
  8825. @item ab2r
  8826. above-below with half height resolution
  8827. (right eye above, left eye below)
  8828. @item al
  8829. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  8830. @item ar
  8831. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  8832. @item irl
  8833. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  8834. @item irr
  8835. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  8836. @item icl
  8837. interleaved columns, left eye first
  8838. @item icr
  8839. interleaved columns, right eye first
  8840. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  8841. @end table
  8842. @item out
  8843. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  8844. @table @samp
  8845. @item sbsl
  8846. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  8847. @item sbsr
  8848. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  8849. @item sbs2l
  8850. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  8851. (left eye left, right eye right)
  8852. @item sbs2r
  8853. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  8854. (right eye left, left eye right)
  8855. @item abl
  8856. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  8857. @item abr
  8858. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  8859. @item ab2l
  8860. above-below with half height resolution
  8861. (left eye above, right eye below)
  8862. @item ab2r
  8863. above-below with half height resolution
  8864. (right eye above, left eye below)
  8865. @item al
  8866. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  8867. @item ar
  8868. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  8869. @item irl
  8870. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  8871. @item irr
  8872. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  8873. @item arbg
  8874. anaglyph red/blue gray
  8875. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  8876. @item argg
  8877. anaglyph red/green gray
  8878. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  8879. @item arcg
  8880. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  8881. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  8882. @item arch
  8883. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  8884. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  8885. @item arcc
  8886. anaglyph red/cyan color
  8887. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  8888. @item arcd
  8889. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  8890. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  8891. @item agmg
  8892. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  8893. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  8894. @item agmh
  8895. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  8896. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  8897. @item agmc
  8898. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  8899. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  8900. @item agmd
  8901. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  8902. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  8903. @item aybg
  8904. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  8905. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  8906. @item aybh
  8907. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  8908. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  8909. @item aybc
  8910. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  8911. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  8912. @item aybd
  8913. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  8914. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  8915. @item ml
  8916. mono output (left eye only)
  8917. @item mr
  8918. mono output (right eye only)
  8919. @item chl
  8920. checkerboard, left eye first
  8921. @item chr
  8922. checkerboard, right eye first
  8923. @item icl
  8924. interleaved columns, left eye first
  8925. @item icr
  8926. interleaved columns, right eye first
  8927. @end table
  8928. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  8929. @end table
  8930. @subsection Examples
  8931. @itemize
  8932. @item
  8933. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  8934. @example
  8935. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  8936. @end example
  8937. @item
  8938. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  8939. @example
  8940. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  8941. @end example
  8942. @end itemize
  8943. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  8944. Select video or audio streams.
  8945. The filter accepts the following options:
  8946. @table @option
  8947. @item inputs
  8948. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  8949. @item map
  8950. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  8951. @end table
  8952. @subsection Commands
  8953. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  8954. commands:
  8955. @table @option
  8956. @item map
  8957. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  8958. @end table
  8959. @subsection Examples
  8960. @itemize
  8961. @item
  8962. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  8963. @example
  8964. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  8965. @end example
  8966. @item
  8967. Same as above, but for audio:
  8968. @example
  8969. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  8970. @end example
  8971. @end itemize
  8972. @anchor{spp}
  8973. @section spp
  8974. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  8975. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  8976. and average the results.
  8977. The filter accepts the following options:
  8978. @table @option
  8979. @item quality
  8980. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8981. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  8982. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  8983. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  8984. @code{3}.
  8985. @item qp
  8986. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  8987. from the video stream (if available).
  8988. @item mode
  8989. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  8990. @table @samp
  8991. @item hard
  8992. Set hard thresholding (default).
  8993. @item soft
  8994. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  8995. @end table
  8996. @item use_bframe_qp
  8997. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8998. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8999. @code{0} (not enabled).
  9000. @end table
  9001. @anchor{subtitles}
  9002. @section subtitles
  9003. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  9004. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  9005. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  9006. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  9007. Alpha) subtitles format.
  9008. The filter accepts the following options:
  9009. @table @option
  9010. @item filename, f
  9011. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  9012. @item original_size
  9013. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  9014. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9015. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9016. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  9017. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  9018. @item fontsdir
  9019. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  9020. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  9021. @item charenc
  9022. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  9023. useful if not UTF-8.
  9024. @item stream_index, si
  9025. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  9026. @item force_style
  9027. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  9028. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  9029. @end table
  9030. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  9031. specifies the @option{filename}.
  9032. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  9033. video, use the command:
  9034. @example
  9035. subtitles=sub.srt
  9036. @end example
  9037. which is equivalent to:
  9038. @example
  9039. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  9040. @end example
  9041. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  9042. @example
  9043. subtitles=video.mkv
  9044. @end example
  9045. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  9046. @example
  9047. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  9048. @end example
  9049. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in transparent green
  9050. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  9051. @example
  9052. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HAA00FF00'
  9053. @end example
  9054. @section super2xsai
  9055. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  9056. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  9057. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  9058. @section swaprect
  9059. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  9060. This filter accepts the following options:
  9061. @table @option
  9062. @item w
  9063. Set object width.
  9064. @item h
  9065. Set object height.
  9066. @item x1
  9067. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  9068. @item y1
  9069. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  9070. @item x2
  9071. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  9072. @item y2
  9073. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  9074. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  9075. @end table
  9076. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  9077. @table @option
  9078. @item w
  9079. @item h
  9080. The input width and height.
  9081. @item a
  9082. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  9083. @item sar
  9084. input sample aspect ratio
  9085. @item dar
  9086. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  9087. @item n
  9088. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  9089. @item t
  9090. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  9091. @item pos
  9092. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  9093. @end table
  9094. @section swapuv
  9095. Swap U & V plane.
  9096. @section telecine
  9097. Apply telecine process to the video.
  9098. This filter accepts the following options:
  9099. @table @option
  9100. @item first_field
  9101. @table @samp
  9102. @item top, t
  9103. top field first
  9104. @item bottom, b
  9105. bottom field first
  9106. The default value is @code{top}.
  9107. @end table
  9108. @item pattern
  9109. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  9110. The default value is @code{23}.
  9111. @end table
  9112. @example
  9113. Some typical patterns:
  9114. NTSC output (30i):
  9115. 27.5p: 32222
  9116. 24p: 23 (classic)
  9117. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  9118. 20p: 33
  9119. 18p: 334
  9120. 16p: 3444
  9121. PAL output (25i):
  9122. 27.5p: 12222
  9123. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  9124. 16.67p: 33
  9125. 16p: 33333334
  9126. @end example
  9127. @section thumbnail
  9128. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  9129. The filter accepts the following options:
  9130. @table @option
  9131. @item n
  9132. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  9133. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  9134. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  9135. @end table
  9136. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  9137. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  9138. @subsection Examples
  9139. @itemize
  9140. @item
  9141. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  9142. @example
  9143. thumbnail=50
  9144. @end example
  9145. @item
  9146. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9147. @example
  9148. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  9149. @end example
  9150. @end itemize
  9151. @section tile
  9152. Tile several successive frames together.
  9153. The filter accepts the following options:
  9154. @table @option
  9155. @item layout
  9156. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  9157. this option, check the
  9158. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9159. @item nb_frames
  9160. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  9161. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  9162. the area will be used.
  9163. @item margin
  9164. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  9165. @item padding
  9166. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  9167. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  9168. refer to the pad video filter.
  9169. @item color
  9170. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9171. "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. The default value of @var{color}
  9172. is "black".
  9173. @end table
  9174. @subsection Examples
  9175. @itemize
  9176. @item
  9177. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  9178. @example
  9179. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  9180. @end example
  9181. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  9182. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  9183. rate.
  9184. @item
  9185. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  9186. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  9187. mixed flat and named options:
  9188. @example
  9189. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  9190. @end example
  9191. @end itemize
  9192. @section tinterlace
  9193. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  9194. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  9195. considered odd.
  9196. The filter accepts the following options:
  9197. @table @option
  9198. @item mode
  9199. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  9200. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  9201. Available values are:
  9202. @table @samp
  9203. @item merge, 0
  9204. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  9205. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  9206. @example
  9207. ------> time
  9208. Input:
  9209. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9210. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9211. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9212. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9213. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9214. Output:
  9215. 11111 33333
  9216. 22222 44444
  9217. 11111 33333
  9218. 22222 44444
  9219. 11111 33333
  9220. 22222 44444
  9221. 11111 33333
  9222. 22222 44444
  9223. @end example
  9224. @item drop_odd, 1
  9225. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  9226. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  9227. @example
  9228. ------> time
  9229. Input:
  9230. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9231. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9232. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9233. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9234. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9235. Output:
  9236. 22222 44444
  9237. 22222 44444
  9238. 22222 44444
  9239. 22222 44444
  9240. @end example
  9241. @item drop_even, 2
  9242. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  9243. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  9244. @example
  9245. ------> time
  9246. Input:
  9247. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9248. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9249. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9250. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9251. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9252. Output:
  9253. 11111 33333
  9254. 11111 33333
  9255. 11111 33333
  9256. 11111 33333
  9257. @end example
  9258. @item pad, 3
  9259. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  9260. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  9261. @example
  9262. ------> time
  9263. Input:
  9264. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9265. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9266. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9267. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9268. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9269. Output:
  9270. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  9271. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  9272. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  9273. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  9274. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  9275. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  9276. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  9277. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  9278. @end example
  9279. @item interleave_top, 4
  9280. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  9281. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  9282. @example
  9283. ------> time
  9284. Input:
  9285. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9286. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  9287. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  9288. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  9289. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  9290. Output:
  9291. 11111 33333
  9292. 22222 44444
  9293. 11111 33333
  9294. 22222 44444
  9295. @end example
  9296. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  9297. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  9298. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  9299. @example
  9300. ------> time
  9301. Input:
  9302. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9303. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  9304. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  9305. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  9306. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  9307. Output:
  9308. 22222 44444
  9309. 11111 33333
  9310. 22222 44444
  9311. 11111 33333
  9312. @end example
  9313. @item interlacex2, 6
  9314. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  9315. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  9316. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  9317. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  9318. field synchronisation.
  9319. @example
  9320. ------> time
  9321. Input:
  9322. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9323. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9324. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9325. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9326. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9327. Output:
  9328. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  9329. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  9330. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  9331. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  9332. @end example
  9333. @item mergex2, 7
  9334. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  9335. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  9336. @example
  9337. ------> time
  9338. Input:
  9339. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9340. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9341. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9342. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9343. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9344. Output:
  9345. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  9346. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  9347. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  9348. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  9349. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  9350. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  9351. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  9352. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  9353. @end example
  9354. @end table
  9355. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  9356. compatibility reasons.
  9357. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  9358. @item flags
  9359. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  9360. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  9361. @table @option
  9362. @item low_pass_filter, vlfp
  9363. Enable vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  9364. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  9365. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  9366. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  9367. patterning.
  9368. Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
  9369. @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  9370. @end table
  9371. @end table
  9372. @section transpose
  9373. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  9374. It accepts the following parameters:
  9375. @table @option
  9376. @item dir
  9377. Specify the transposition direction.
  9378. Can assume the following values:
  9379. @table @samp
  9380. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  9381. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  9382. @example
  9383. L.R L.l
  9384. . . -> . .
  9385. l.r R.r
  9386. @end example
  9387. @item 1, 5, clock
  9388. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  9389. @example
  9390. L.R l.L
  9391. . . -> . .
  9392. l.r r.R
  9393. @end example
  9394. @item 2, 6, cclock
  9395. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  9396. @example
  9397. L.R R.r
  9398. . . -> . .
  9399. l.r L.l
  9400. @end example
  9401. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  9402. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  9403. @example
  9404. L.R r.R
  9405. . . -> . .
  9406. l.r l.L
  9407. @end example
  9408. @end table
  9409. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  9410. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  9411. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  9412. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  9413. symbolic constants.
  9414. @item passthrough
  9415. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  9416. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  9417. @table @samp
  9418. @item none
  9419. Always apply transposition.
  9420. @item portrait
  9421. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  9422. @item landscape
  9423. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  9424. @end table
  9425. Default value is @code{none}.
  9426. @end table
  9427. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  9428. layout:
  9429. @example
  9430. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  9431. @end example
  9432. The command above can also be specified as:
  9433. @example
  9434. transpose=1:portrait
  9435. @end example
  9436. @section trim
  9437. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  9438. It accepts the following parameters:
  9439. @table @option
  9440. @item start
  9441. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  9442. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  9443. @item end
  9444. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  9445. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  9446. frame in the output.
  9447. @item start_pts
  9448. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  9449. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  9450. @item end_pts
  9451. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  9452. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  9453. @item duration
  9454. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  9455. @item start_frame
  9456. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  9457. @item end_frame
  9458. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  9459. @end table
  9460. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  9461. duration specifications; see
  9462. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  9463. for the accepted syntax.
  9464. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  9465. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  9466. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  9467. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  9468. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  9469. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  9470. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  9471. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  9472. filters.
  9473. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  9474. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  9475. Examples:
  9476. @itemize
  9477. @item
  9478. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  9479. @example
  9480. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  9481. @end example
  9482. @item
  9483. Keep only the first second:
  9484. @example
  9485. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  9486. @end example
  9487. @end itemize
  9488. @anchor{unsharp}
  9489. @section unsharp
  9490. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  9491. It accepts the following parameters:
  9492. @table @option
  9493. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  9494. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  9495. 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
  9496. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  9497. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  9498. and 63. The default value is 5.
  9499. @item luma_amount, la
  9500. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  9501. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  9502. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  9503. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  9504. Default value is 1.0.
  9505. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  9506. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  9507. between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
  9508. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  9509. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  9510. between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
  9511. @item chroma_amount, ca
  9512. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  9513. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  9514. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  9515. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  9516. Default value is 0.0.
  9517. @item opencl
  9518. If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
  9519. FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
  9520. @end table
  9521. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  9522. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  9523. @subsection Examples
  9524. @itemize
  9525. @item
  9526. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  9527. @example
  9528. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  9529. @end example
  9530. @item
  9531. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  9532. @example
  9533. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  9534. @end example
  9535. @end itemize
  9536. @section uspp
  9537. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  9538. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  9539. shifts and average the results.
  9540. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  9541. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  9542. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  9543. The filter accepts the following options:
  9544. @table @option
  9545. @item quality
  9546. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  9547. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  9548. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  9549. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  9550. @code{3}.
  9551. @item qp
  9552. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  9553. from the video stream (if available).
  9554. @end table
  9555. @section vectorscope
  9556. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  9557. a vectorscope).
  9558. This filter accepts the following options:
  9559. @table @option
  9560. @item mode, m
  9561. Set vectorscope mode.
  9562. It accepts the following values:
  9563. @table @samp
  9564. @item gray
  9565. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  9566. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  9567. @item color
  9568. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  9569. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  9570. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}.
  9571. @item color2
  9572. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  9573. @item color3
  9574. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  9575. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  9576. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  9577. @item color4
  9578. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  9579. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  9580. not present in graph is picked.
  9581. @end table
  9582. @item x
  9583. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  9584. @item y
  9585. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  9586. @item intensity, i
  9587. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color and color3 for increasing brightness
  9588. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  9589. @item envelope, e
  9590. @table @samp
  9591. @item none
  9592. No envelope, this is default.
  9593. @item instant
  9594. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  9595. @item peak
  9596. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  9597. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  9598. @item peak+instant
  9599. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  9600. @end table
  9601. @end table
  9602. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  9603. @section vidstabdetect
  9604. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  9605. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  9606. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  9607. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  9608. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  9609. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  9610. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  9611. This filter accepts the following options:
  9612. @table @option
  9613. @item result
  9614. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  9615. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  9616. @item shakiness
  9617. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  9618. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  9619. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  9620. @item accuracy
  9621. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  9622. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  9623. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  9624. @item stepsize
  9625. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  9626. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  9627. @item mincontrast
  9628. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  9629. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  9630. value is 0.3.
  9631. @item tripod
  9632. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  9633. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  9634. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  9635. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  9636. the camera view absolutely still.
  9637. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  9638. @item show
  9639. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  9640. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  9641. visualization.
  9642. @end table
  9643. @subsection Examples
  9644. @itemize
  9645. @item
  9646. Use default values:
  9647. @example
  9648. vidstabdetect
  9649. @end example
  9650. @item
  9651. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  9652. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  9653. @example
  9654. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  9655. @end example
  9656. @item
  9657. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  9658. video:
  9659. @example
  9660. vidstabdetect=show=1
  9661. @end example
  9662. @item
  9663. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  9664. @example
  9665. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  9666. @end example
  9667. @end itemize
  9668. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  9669. @section vidstabtransform
  9670. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  9671. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  9672. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  9673. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  9674. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  9675. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  9676. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  9677. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  9678. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  9679. @subsection Options
  9680. @table @option
  9681. @item input
  9682. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  9683. @file{transforms.trf}.
  9684. @item smoothing
  9685. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  9686. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  9687. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  9688. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  9689. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  9690. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  9691. camera is simulated.
  9692. @item optalgo
  9693. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  9694. Accepted values are:
  9695. @table @samp
  9696. @item gauss
  9697. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  9698. @item avg
  9699. averaging on transformations
  9700. @end table
  9701. @item maxshift
  9702. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  9703. meaning no limit.
  9704. @item maxangle
  9705. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  9706. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  9707. @item crop
  9708. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  9709. compensation.
  9710. Available values are:
  9711. @table @samp
  9712. @item keep
  9713. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  9714. @item black
  9715. fill the border black
  9716. @end table
  9717. @item invert
  9718. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  9719. @item relative
  9720. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  9721. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  9722. @item zoom
  9723. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  9724. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  9725. zoom).
  9726. @item optzoom
  9727. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  9728. Accepted values are:
  9729. @table @samp
  9730. @item 0
  9731. disabled
  9732. @item 1
  9733. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  9734. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  9735. @item 2
  9736. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  9737. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  9738. @end table
  9739. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  9740. @item zoomspeed
  9741. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  9742. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  9743. 0.25.
  9744. @item interpol
  9745. Specify type of interpolation.
  9746. Available values are:
  9747. @table @samp
  9748. @item no
  9749. no interpolation
  9750. @item linear
  9751. linear only horizontal
  9752. @item bilinear
  9753. linear in both directions (default)
  9754. @item bicubic
  9755. cubic in both directions (slow)
  9756. @end table
  9757. @item tripod
  9758. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  9759. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  9760. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  9761. @item debug
  9762. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  9763. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  9764. value is 0.
  9765. @end table
  9766. @subsection Examples
  9767. @itemize
  9768. @item
  9769. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  9770. @example
  9771. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  9772. @end example
  9773. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  9774. @item
  9775. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  9776. @example
  9777. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  9778. @end example
  9779. @item
  9780. Smoothen the video even more:
  9781. @example
  9782. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  9783. @end example
  9784. @end itemize
  9785. @section vflip
  9786. Flip the input video vertically.
  9787. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9788. @example
  9789. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  9790. @end example
  9791. @anchor{vignette}
  9792. @section vignette
  9793. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  9794. The filter accepts the following options:
  9795. @table @option
  9796. @item angle, a
  9797. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  9798. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  9799. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  9800. @item x0
  9801. @item y0
  9802. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  9803. by default.
  9804. @item mode
  9805. Set forward/backward mode.
  9806. Available modes are:
  9807. @table @samp
  9808. @item forward
  9809. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  9810. @item backward
  9811. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  9812. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  9813. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  9814. also be used to create a burning effect.
  9815. @end table
  9816. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  9817. @item eval
  9818. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  9819. It accepts the following values:
  9820. @table @samp
  9821. @item init
  9822. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  9823. @item frame
  9824. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  9825. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  9826. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  9827. @end table
  9828. Default value is @samp{init}.
  9829. @item dither
  9830. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  9831. (enabled).
  9832. @item aspect
  9833. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  9834. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  9835. following the dimensions of the video.
  9836. Default is @code{1/1}.
  9837. @end table
  9838. @subsection Expressions
  9839. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  9840. following parameters.
  9841. @table @option
  9842. @item w
  9843. @item h
  9844. input width and height
  9845. @item n
  9846. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  9847. @item pts
  9848. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  9849. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  9850. @item r
  9851. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9852. @item t
  9853. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  9854. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  9855. @item tb
  9856. time base of the input video
  9857. @end table
  9858. @subsection Examples
  9859. @itemize
  9860. @item
  9861. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  9862. @example
  9863. vignette=PI/4
  9864. @end example
  9865. @item
  9866. Make a flickering vignetting:
  9867. @example
  9868. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  9869. @end example
  9870. @end itemize
  9871. @section vstack
  9872. Stack input videos vertically.
  9873. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  9874. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9875. to create same output.
  9876. The filter accept the following option:
  9877. @table @option
  9878. @item inputs
  9879. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9880. @item shortest
  9881. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9882. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9883. @end table
  9884. @section w3fdif
  9885. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  9886. Deinterlacing Filter").
  9887. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  9888. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  9889. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  9890. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  9891. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple":
  9892. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  9893. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  9894. @table @option
  9895. @item filter
  9896. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  9897. @table @samp
  9898. @item simple
  9899. Simple filter coefficient set.
  9900. @item complex
  9901. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  9902. @end table
  9903. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  9904. @item deint
  9905. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following values:
  9906. @table @samp
  9907. @item all
  9908. Deinterlace all frames,
  9909. @item interlaced
  9910. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  9911. @end table
  9912. Default value is @samp{all}.
  9913. @end table
  9914. @section waveform
  9915. Video waveform monitor.
  9916. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  9917. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  9918. source video.
  9919. It accepts the following options:
  9920. @table @option
  9921. @item mode, m
  9922. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  9923. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  9924. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  9925. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  9926. @item intensity, i
  9927. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  9928. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  9929. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  9930. @item mirror, r
  9931. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  9932. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  9933. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  9934. @code{1} (mirrored).
  9935. @item display, d
  9936. Set display mode.
  9937. It accepts the following values:
  9938. @table @samp
  9939. @item overlay
  9940. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  9941. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  9942. over one another.
  9943. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  9944. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  9945. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  9946. @item parade
  9947. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  9948. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  9949. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  9950. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  9951. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  9952. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  9953. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  9954. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  9955. @end table
  9956. Default is @code{parade}.
  9957. @item components, c
  9958. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  9959. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  9960. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  9961. @item envelope, e
  9962. @table @samp
  9963. @item none
  9964. No envelope, this is default.
  9965. @item instant
  9966. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  9967. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  9968. @item peak
  9969. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  9970. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  9971. @item peak+instant
  9972. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  9973. @end table
  9974. @item filter, f
  9975. @table @samp
  9976. @item lowpass
  9977. No filtering, this is default.
  9978. @item flat
  9979. Luma and chroma combined together.
  9980. @item aflat
  9981. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  9982. @item chroma
  9983. Displays only chroma.
  9984. @item achroma
  9985. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  9986. @item color
  9987. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  9988. @end table
  9989. @end table
  9990. @section xbr
  9991. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  9992. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  9993. @url{http://www.libretro.com/forums/viewtopic.php?f=6&t=134}.
  9994. It accepts the following option:
  9995. @table @option
  9996. @item n
  9997. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  9998. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  9999. Default is @code{3}.
  10000. @end table
  10001. @anchor{yadif}
  10002. @section yadif
  10003. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  10004. filter").
  10005. It accepts the following parameters:
  10006. @table @option
  10007. @item mode
  10008. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  10009. @table @option
  10010. @item 0, send_frame
  10011. Output one frame for each frame.
  10012. @item 1, send_field
  10013. Output one frame for each field.
  10014. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  10015. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  10016. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  10017. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  10018. @end table
  10019. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  10020. @item parity
  10021. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  10022. of the following values:
  10023. @table @option
  10024. @item 0, tff
  10025. Assume the top field is first.
  10026. @item 1, bff
  10027. Assume the bottom field is first.
  10028. @item -1, auto
  10029. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  10030. @end table
  10031. The default value is @code{auto}.
  10032. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  10033. top field first will be assumed.
  10034. @item deint
  10035. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
  10036. values:
  10037. @table @option
  10038. @item 0, all
  10039. Deinterlace all frames.
  10040. @item 1, interlaced
  10041. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  10042. @end table
  10043. The default value is @code{all}.
  10044. @end table
  10045. @section zoompan
  10046. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  10047. This filter accepts the following options:
  10048. @table @option
  10049. @item zoom, z
  10050. Set the zoom expression. Default is 1.
  10051. @item x
  10052. @item y
  10053. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  10054. @item d
  10055. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  10056. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  10057. single input image.
  10058. @item s
  10059. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  10060. @item fps
  10061. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  10062. @end table
  10063. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  10064. @table @option
  10065. @item in_w, iw
  10066. Input width.
  10067. @item in_h, ih
  10068. Input height.
  10069. @item out_w, ow
  10070. Output width.
  10071. @item out_h, oh
  10072. Output height.
  10073. @item in
  10074. Input frame count.
  10075. @item on
  10076. Output frame count.
  10077. @item x
  10078. @item y
  10079. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  10080. for current input frame.
  10081. @item px
  10082. @item py
  10083. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  10084. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  10085. @item zoom
  10086. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  10087. @item pzoom
  10088. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  10089. @item duration
  10090. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  10091. for each input frame.
  10092. @item pduration
  10093. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  10094. @item a
  10095. Rational number: input width / input height
  10096. @item sar
  10097. sample aspect ratio
  10098. @item dar
  10099. display aspect ratio
  10100. @end table
  10101. @subsection Examples
  10102. @itemize
  10103. @item
  10104. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  10105. @example
  10106. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  10107. @end example
  10108. @item
  10109. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  10110. @example
  10111. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  10112. @end example
  10113. @end itemize
  10114. @section zscale
  10115. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  10116. https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg.
  10117. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  10118. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  10119. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  10120. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  10121. requested format.
  10122. @subsection Options
  10123. The filter accepts the following options.
  10124. @table @option
  10125. @item width, w
  10126. @item height, h
  10127. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  10128. dimension.
  10129. If the @var{width} or @var{w} is 0, the input width is used for the output.
  10130. If the @var{height} or @var{h} is 0, the input height is used for the output.
  10131. If one of the values is -1, the zscale filter will use a value that
  10132. maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
  10133. other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
  10134. used
  10135. If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the zscale filter will also use a value
  10136. that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
  10137. specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
  10138. dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
  10139. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  10140. expression.
  10141. @item size, s
  10142. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10143. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10144. @item dither, d
  10145. Set the dither type.
  10146. Possible values are:
  10147. @table @var
  10148. @item none
  10149. @item ordered
  10150. @item random
  10151. @item error_diffusion
  10152. @end table
  10153. Default is none.
  10154. @item filter, f
  10155. Set the resize filter type.
  10156. Possible values are:
  10157. @table @var
  10158. @item point
  10159. @item bilinear
  10160. @item bicubic
  10161. @item spline16
  10162. @item spline36
  10163. @item lanczos
  10164. @end table
  10165. Default is bilinear.
  10166. @item range, r
  10167. Set the color range.
  10168. Possible values are:
  10169. @table @var
  10170. @item input
  10171. @item limited
  10172. @item full
  10173. @end table
  10174. Default is same as input.
  10175. @item primaries, p
  10176. Set the color primaries.
  10177. Possible values are:
  10178. @table @var
  10179. @item input
  10180. @item 709
  10181. @item unspecified
  10182. @item 170m
  10183. @item 240m
  10184. @item 2020
  10185. @end table
  10186. Default is same as input.
  10187. @item transfer, t
  10188. Set the transfer characteristics.
  10189. Possible values are:
  10190. @table @var
  10191. @item input
  10192. @item 709
  10193. @item unspecified
  10194. @item 601
  10195. @item linear
  10196. @item 2020_10
  10197. @item 2020_12
  10198. @end table
  10199. Default is same as input.
  10200. @item matrix, m
  10201. Set the colorspace matrix.
  10202. Possible value are:
  10203. @table @var
  10204. @item input
  10205. @item 709
  10206. @item unspecified
  10207. @item 470bg
  10208. @item 170m
  10209. @item 2020_ncl
  10210. @item 2020_cl
  10211. @end table
  10212. Default is same as input.
  10213. @item rangein, rin
  10214. Set the input color range.
  10215. Possible values are:
  10216. @table @var
  10217. @item input
  10218. @item limited
  10219. @item full
  10220. @end table
  10221. Default is same as input.
  10222. @item primariesin, pin
  10223. Set the input color primaries.
  10224. Possible values are:
  10225. @table @var
  10226. @item input
  10227. @item 709
  10228. @item unspecified
  10229. @item 170m
  10230. @item 240m
  10231. @item 2020
  10232. @end table
  10233. Default is same as input.
  10234. @item transferin, tin
  10235. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  10236. Possible values are:
  10237. @table @var
  10238. @item input
  10239. @item 709
  10240. @item unspecified
  10241. @item 601
  10242. @item linear
  10243. @item 2020_10
  10244. @item 2020_12
  10245. @end table
  10246. Default is same as input.
  10247. @item matrixin, min
  10248. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  10249. Possible value are:
  10250. @table @var
  10251. @item input
  10252. @item 709
  10253. @item unspecified
  10254. @item 470bg
  10255. @item 170m
  10256. @item 2020_ncl
  10257. @item 2020_cl
  10258. @end table
  10259. @end table
  10260. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  10261. containing the following constants:
  10262. @table @var
  10263. @item in_w
  10264. @item in_h
  10265. The input width and height
  10266. @item iw
  10267. @item ih
  10268. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  10269. @item out_w
  10270. @item out_h
  10271. The output (scaled) width and height
  10272. @item ow
  10273. @item oh
  10274. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  10275. @item a
  10276. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  10277. @item sar
  10278. input sample aspect ratio
  10279. @item dar
  10280. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  10281. @item hsub
  10282. @item vsub
  10283. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  10284. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  10285. @item ohsub
  10286. @item ovsub
  10287. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  10288. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  10289. @end table
  10290. @table @option
  10291. @end table
  10292. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  10293. @chapter Video Sources
  10294. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  10295. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  10296. @section buffer
  10297. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  10298. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  10299. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  10300. It accepts the following parameters:
  10301. @table @option
  10302. @item video_size
  10303. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  10304. syntax of this option, check the
  10305. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10306. @item width
  10307. The input video width.
  10308. @item height
  10309. The input video height.
  10310. @item pix_fmt
  10311. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  10312. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  10313. name.
  10314. @item time_base
  10315. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  10316. @item frame_rate
  10317. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  10318. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  10319. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  10320. @item sws_param
  10321. Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
  10322. is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
  10323. input size or format.
  10324. @item hw_frames_ctx
  10325. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  10326. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  10327. @end table
  10328. For example:
  10329. @example
  10330. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  10331. @end example
  10332. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  10333. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  10334. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  10335. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  10336. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  10337. this example corresponds to:
  10338. @example
  10339. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  10340. @end example
  10341. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  10342. syntax is deprecated:
  10343. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
  10344. @section cellauto
  10345. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  10346. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  10347. @option{filename}, and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  10348. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  10349. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  10350. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  10351. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  10352. This source accepts the following options:
  10353. @table @option
  10354. @item filename, f
  10355. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  10356. the specified file.
  10357. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  10358. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  10359. file will be ignored.
  10360. @item pattern, p
  10361. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  10362. the specified string.
  10363. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  10364. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  10365. string will be ignored.
  10366. @item rate, r
  10367. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  10368. Default is 25.
  10369. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  10370. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  10371. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  10372. 1/PHI.
  10373. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  10374. @item random_seed, seed
  10375. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  10376. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  10377. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  10378. effort basis.
  10379. @item rule
  10380. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  10381. Default value is 110.
  10382. @item size, s
  10383. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10384. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10385. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  10386. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  10387. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  10388. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  10389. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  10390. larger row.
  10391. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  10392. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  10393. @item scroll
  10394. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  10395. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  10396. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  10397. Defaults to 1.
  10398. @item start_full, full
  10399. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  10400. outputting the first frame.
  10401. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  10402. @item stitch
  10403. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  10404. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  10405. @end table
  10406. @subsection Examples
  10407. @itemize
  10408. @item
  10409. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  10410. size 200x400.
  10411. @example
  10412. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  10413. @end example
  10414. @item
  10415. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  10416. ratio of 2/3:
  10417. @example
  10418. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  10419. @end example
  10420. @item
  10421. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  10422. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  10423. @example
  10424. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  10425. @end example
  10426. @item
  10427. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  10428. @example
  10429. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  10430. @end example
  10431. @end itemize
  10432. @section mandelbrot
  10433. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  10434. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  10435. This source accepts the following options:
  10436. @table @option
  10437. @item end_pts
  10438. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  10439. @item end_scale
  10440. Set the terminal scale value.
  10441. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  10442. @item inner
  10443. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  10444. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  10445. It shall assume one of the following values:
  10446. @table @option
  10447. @item black
  10448. Set black mode.
  10449. @item convergence
  10450. Show time until convergence.
  10451. @item mincol
  10452. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  10453. @item period
  10454. Set period mode.
  10455. @end table
  10456. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  10457. @item bailout
  10458. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  10459. @item maxiter
  10460. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  10461. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  10462. @item outer
  10463. Set outer coloring mode.
  10464. It shall assume one of following values:
  10465. @table @option
  10466. @item iteration_count
  10467. Set iteration cound mode.
  10468. @item normalized_iteration_count
  10469. set normalized iteration count mode.
  10470. @end table
  10471. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  10472. @item rate, r
  10473. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  10474. value is "25".
  10475. @item size, s
  10476. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video
  10477. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default value is "640x480".
  10478. @item start_scale
  10479. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  10480. @item start_x
  10481. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  10482. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  10483. @item start_y
  10484. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  10485. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  10486. @end table
  10487. @section mptestsrc
  10488. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  10489. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  10490. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  10491. This source accepts the following options:
  10492. @table @option
  10493. @item rate, r
  10494. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  10495. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  10496. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  10497. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  10498. "25".
  10499. @item duration, d
  10500. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  10501. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  10502. for the accepted syntax.
  10503. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  10504. supposed to be generated forever.
  10505. @item test, t
  10506. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  10507. @table @option
  10508. @item dc_luma
  10509. @item dc_chroma
  10510. @item freq_luma
  10511. @item freq_chroma
  10512. @item amp_luma
  10513. @item amp_chroma
  10514. @item cbp
  10515. @item mv
  10516. @item ring1
  10517. @item ring2
  10518. @item all
  10519. @end table
  10520. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  10521. @end table
  10522. Some examples:
  10523. @example
  10524. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  10525. @end example
  10526. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  10527. @section frei0r_src
  10528. Provide a frei0r source.
  10529. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  10530. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  10531. This source accepts the following parameters:
  10532. @table @option
  10533. @item size
  10534. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10535. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10536. @item framerate
  10537. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  10538. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  10539. @item filter_name
  10540. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  10541. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  10542. documentation.
  10543. @item filter_params
  10544. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  10545. @end table
  10546. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  10547. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  10548. @example
  10549. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  10550. @end example
  10551. @section life
  10552. Generate a life pattern.
  10553. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  10554. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  10555. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  10556. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  10557. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  10558. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  10559. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  10560. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  10561. the rule to adopt.
  10562. This source accepts the following options:
  10563. @table @option
  10564. @item filename, f
  10565. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  10566. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  10567. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  10568. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  10569. randomly.
  10570. @item rate, r
  10571. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  10572. Default is 25.
  10573. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  10574. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  10575. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  10576. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  10577. @item random_seed, seed
  10578. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  10579. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  10580. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  10581. effort basis.
  10582. @item rule
  10583. Set the life rule.
  10584. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  10585. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  10586. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  10587. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  10588. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  10589. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  10590. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  10591. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  10592. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  10593. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  10594. higher number of neighbor cells.
  10595. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  10596. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  10597. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  10598. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  10599. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  10600. a dead cell.
  10601. @item size, s
  10602. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10603. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10604. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  10605. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  10606. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  10607. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  10608. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  10609. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  10610. @item stitch
  10611. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  10612. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  10613. @item mold
  10614. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  10615. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  10616. value from 0 to 255.
  10617. @item life_color
  10618. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  10619. @item death_color
  10620. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  10621. used to represent a dead cell.
  10622. @item mold_color
  10623. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  10624. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the "Color" section in the
  10625. ffmpeg-utils manual.
  10626. @end table
  10627. @subsection Examples
  10628. @itemize
  10629. @item
  10630. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  10631. 300x300 pixels:
  10632. @example
  10633. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  10634. @end example
  10635. @item
  10636. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  10637. @example
  10638. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  10639. @end example
  10640. @item
  10641. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  10642. @example
  10643. life=rule=S14/B34
  10644. @end example
  10645. @item
  10646. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  10647. @example
  10648. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  10649. @end example
  10650. @end itemize
  10651. @anchor{allrgb}
  10652. @anchor{allyuv}
  10653. @anchor{color}
  10654. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  10655. @anchor{nullsrc}
  10656. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  10657. @anchor{smptebars}
  10658. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  10659. @anchor{testsrc}
  10660. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc
  10661. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  10662. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  10663. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  10664. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  10665. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  10666. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  10667. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  10668. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  10669. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  10670. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  10671. stripe from top to bottom.
  10672. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  10673. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  10674. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  10675. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  10676. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  10677. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  10678. intended for testing purposes.
  10679. The sources accept the following parameters:
  10680. @table @option
  10681. @item color, c
  10682. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  10683. source. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
  10684. ffmpeg-utils manual.
  10685. @item level
  10686. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  10687. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  10688. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  10689. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  10690. @item size, s
  10691. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10692. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10693. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  10694. This option is not available with the @code{haldclutsrc} filter.
  10695. @item rate, r
  10696. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  10697. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  10698. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  10699. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  10700. "25".
  10701. @item sar
  10702. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  10703. @item duration, d
  10704. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  10705. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  10706. for the accepted syntax.
  10707. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  10708. supposed to be generated forever.
  10709. @item decimals, n
  10710. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  10711. @code{testsrc} source.
  10712. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  10713. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  10714. value. Default value is 0.
  10715. @end table
  10716. For example the following:
  10717. @example
  10718. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  10719. @end example
  10720. will generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  10721. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second.
  10722. The following graph description will generate a red source
  10723. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  10724. frames per second.
  10725. @example
  10726. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  10727. @end example
  10728. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  10729. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  10730. the @code{geq} filter:
  10731. @example
  10732. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  10733. @end example
  10734. @subsection Commands
  10735. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  10736. @table @option
  10737. @item c, color
  10738. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  10739. corresponding @option{color} option.
  10740. @end table
  10741. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  10742. @chapter Video Sinks
  10743. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  10744. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  10745. @section buffersink
  10746. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  10747. graph.
  10748. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  10749. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  10750. or the options system.
  10751. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  10752. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  10753. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  10754. @section nullsink
  10755. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  10756. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  10757. tools.
  10758. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  10759. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  10760. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  10761. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  10762. @section ahistogram
  10763. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  10764. The filter accepts the following options:
  10765. @table @option
  10766. @item dmode
  10767. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  10768. It accepts the following values:
  10769. @table @samp
  10770. @item single
  10771. Use single histogram for all channels.
  10772. @item separate
  10773. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  10774. @end table
  10775. Default is @code{single}.
  10776. @item rate, r
  10777. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  10778. value is "25".
  10779. @item size, s
  10780. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10781. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10782. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  10783. @item scale
  10784. Set display scale.
  10785. It accepts the following values:
  10786. @table @samp
  10787. @item log
  10788. logarithmic
  10789. @item sqrt
  10790. square root
  10791. @item cbrt
  10792. cubic root
  10793. @item lin
  10794. linear
  10795. @item rlog
  10796. reverse logarithmic
  10797. @end table
  10798. Default is @code{log}.
  10799. @item ascale
  10800. Set amplitude scale.
  10801. It accepts the following values:
  10802. @table @samp
  10803. @item log
  10804. logarithmic
  10805. @item lin
  10806. linear
  10807. @end table
  10808. Default is @code{log}.
  10809. @item acount
  10810. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  10811. Defauls is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  10812. @item rheight
  10813. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  10814. @item slide
  10815. Set sonogram sliding.
  10816. It accepts the following values:
  10817. @table @samp
  10818. @item replace
  10819. replace old rows with new ones.
  10820. @item scroll
  10821. scroll from top to bottom.
  10822. @end table
  10823. Default is @code{replace}.
  10824. @end table
  10825. @section aphasemeter
  10826. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio phase.
  10827. The filter accepts the following options:
  10828. @table @option
  10829. @item rate, r
  10830. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  10831. @item size, s
  10832. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10833. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10834. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  10835. @item rc
  10836. @item gc
  10837. @item bc
  10838. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  10839. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  10840. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  10841. @item mpc
  10842. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  10843. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  10844. @end table
  10845. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase} which
  10846. represents mean phase of current audio frame. Value is in range @code{[-1, 1]}.
  10847. The @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase and
  10848. @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  10849. @section avectorscope
  10850. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  10851. scope.
  10852. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  10853. audio stream. A monoaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  10854. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  10855. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  10856. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  10857. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  10858. The filter accepts the following options:
  10859. @table @option
  10860. @item mode, m
  10861. Set the vectorscope mode.
  10862. Available values are:
  10863. @table @samp
  10864. @item lissajous
  10865. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  10866. @item lissajous_xy
  10867. Same as above but not rotated.
  10868. @item polar
  10869. Shape resembling half of circle.
  10870. @end table
  10871. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  10872. @item size, s
  10873. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  10874. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10875. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  10876. @item rate, r
  10877. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  10878. @item rc
  10879. @item gc
  10880. @item bc
  10881. @item ac
  10882. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  10883. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  10884. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  10885. @item rf
  10886. @item gf
  10887. @item bf
  10888. @item af
  10889. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  10890. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  10891. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  10892. @item zoom
  10893. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[1, 10]}.
  10894. @item draw
  10895. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  10896. Available values are:
  10897. @table @samp
  10898. @item dot
  10899. Draw dot for each sample.
  10900. @item line
  10901. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  10902. @end table
  10903. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  10904. @end table
  10905. @subsection Examples
  10906. @itemize
  10907. @item
  10908. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  10909. @example
  10910. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  10911. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  10912. @end example
  10913. @end itemize
  10914. @section concat
  10915. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  10916. other.
  10917. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  10918. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  10919. also be the number of streams at output.
  10920. The filter accepts the following options:
  10921. @table @option
  10922. @item n
  10923. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  10924. @item v
  10925. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  10926. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  10927. @item a
  10928. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  10929. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  10930. @item unsafe
  10931. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  10932. @end table
  10933. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  10934. @var{a} audio outputs.
  10935. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  10936. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  10937. segment, etc.
  10938. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  10939. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  10940. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  10941. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  10942. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  10943. audio streams with silence.
  10944. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  10945. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  10946. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  10947. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  10948. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  10949. explicitly by the user.
  10950. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  10951. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  10952. @subsection Examples
  10953. @itemize
  10954. @item
  10955. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  10956. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  10957. @example
  10958. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  10959. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  10960. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  10961. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  10962. @end example
  10963. @item
  10964. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  10965. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  10966. @example
  10967. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  10968. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  10969. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  10970. @end example
  10971. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  10972. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  10973. @end itemize
  10974. @anchor{ebur128}
  10975. @section ebur128
  10976. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as input and outputs
  10977. it unchanged. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  10978. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  10979. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  10980. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  10981. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  10982. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  10983. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  10984. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  10985. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds).
  10986. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  10987. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  10988. The filter accepts the following options:
  10989. @table @option
  10990. @item video
  10991. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  10992. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  10993. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  10994. @item size
  10995. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  10996. option, check the
  10997. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10998. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  10999. @item meter
  11000. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  11001. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  11002. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  11003. @item metadata
  11004. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  11005. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  11006. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  11007. Default is @code{0}.
  11008. @item framelog
  11009. Force the frame logging level.
  11010. Available values are:
  11011. @table @samp
  11012. @item info
  11013. information logging level
  11014. @item verbose
  11015. verbose logging level
  11016. @end table
  11017. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  11018. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  11019. @item peak
  11020. Set peak mode(s).
  11021. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  11022. values are:
  11023. @table @samp
  11024. @item none
  11025. Disable any peak mode (default).
  11026. @item sample
  11027. Enable sample-peak mode.
  11028. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  11029. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  11030. @item true
  11031. Enable true-peak mode.
  11032. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  11033. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  11034. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  11035. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  11036. @end table
  11037. @item dualmono
  11038. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  11039. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  11040. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  11041. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  11042. @item panlaw
  11043. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  11044. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  11045. @end table
  11046. @subsection Examples
  11047. @itemize
  11048. @item
  11049. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  11050. @example
  11051. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  11052. @end example
  11053. @item
  11054. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  11055. @example
  11056. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  11057. @end example
  11058. @end itemize
  11059. @section interleave, ainterleave
  11060. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  11061. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  11062. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  11063. queued frame to the output.
  11064. Input streams must have a well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  11065. timestamp values.
  11066. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  11067. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  11068. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  11069. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  11070. which always drop input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  11071. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  11072. to output until the input will send an end-of-stream signal.
  11073. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  11074. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  11075. the queue is already filled.
  11076. These filters accept the following options:
  11077. @table @option
  11078. @item nb_inputs, n
  11079. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  11080. @end table
  11081. @subsection Examples
  11082. @itemize
  11083. @item
  11084. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11085. @example
  11086. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  11087. @end example
  11088. @item
  11089. Add flickering blur effect:
  11090. @example
  11091. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  11092. @end example
  11093. @end itemize
  11094. @section perms, aperms
  11095. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  11096. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  11097. following filter in the filtergraph.
  11098. The filters accept the following options:
  11099. @table @option
  11100. @item mode
  11101. Select the permissions mode.
  11102. It accepts the following values:
  11103. @table @samp
  11104. @item none
  11105. Do nothing. This is the default.
  11106. @item ro
  11107. Set all the output frames read-only.
  11108. @item rw
  11109. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  11110. @item toggle
  11111. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  11112. @item random
  11113. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  11114. @end table
  11115. @item seed
  11116. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  11117. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11118. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  11119. basis.
  11120. @end table
  11121. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  11122. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  11123. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  11124. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  11125. @section realtime, arealtime
  11126. Slow down filtering to match real time approximatively.
  11127. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  11128. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  11129. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  11130. They accept the following options:
  11131. @table @option
  11132. @item limit
  11133. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  11134. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  11135. @end table
  11136. @section select, aselect
  11137. Select frames to pass in output.
  11138. This filter accepts the following options:
  11139. @table @option
  11140. @item expr, e
  11141. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  11142. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  11143. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  11144. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  11145. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  11146. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  11147. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  11148. @item outputs, n
  11149. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  11150. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  11151. @end table
  11152. The expression can contain the following constants:
  11153. @table @option
  11154. @item n
  11155. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  11156. @item selected_n
  11157. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  11158. @item prev_selected_n
  11159. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  11160. @item TB
  11161. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  11162. @item pts
  11163. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  11164. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  11165. @item t
  11166. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  11167. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  11168. @item prev_pts
  11169. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  11170. @item prev_selected_pts
  11171. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  11172. @item prev_selected_t
  11173. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  11174. @item start_pts
  11175. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  11176. @item start_t
  11177. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  11178. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  11179. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  11180. values:
  11181. @table @option
  11182. @item I
  11183. @item P
  11184. @item B
  11185. @item S
  11186. @item SI
  11187. @item SP
  11188. @item BI
  11189. @end table
  11190. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  11191. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  11192. @table @option
  11193. @item PROGRESSIVE
  11194. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  11195. @item TOPFIRST
  11196. The frame is top-field-first.
  11197. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  11198. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  11199. @end table
  11200. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  11201. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  11202. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  11203. the number of samples in the current frame
  11204. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  11205. the input sample rate
  11206. @item key
  11207. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  11208. @item pos
  11209. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  11210. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  11211. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  11212. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  11213. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  11214. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  11215. @item concatdec_select
  11216. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  11217. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  11218. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  11219. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  11220. interval.
  11221. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  11222. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  11223. present in the decoded frames.
  11224. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  11225. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  11226. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  11227. missing.
  11228. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  11229. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  11230. @end table
  11231. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  11232. @subsection Examples
  11233. @itemize
  11234. @item
  11235. Select all frames in input:
  11236. @example
  11237. select
  11238. @end example
  11239. The example above is the same as:
  11240. @example
  11241. select=1
  11242. @end example
  11243. @item
  11244. Skip all frames:
  11245. @example
  11246. select=0
  11247. @end example
  11248. @item
  11249. Select only I-frames:
  11250. @example
  11251. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  11252. @end example
  11253. @item
  11254. Select one frame every 100:
  11255. @example
  11256. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  11257. @end example
  11258. @item
  11259. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  11260. @example
  11261. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  11262. @end example
  11263. @item
  11264. Select only I frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  11265. @example
  11266. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  11267. @end example
  11268. @item
  11269. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  11270. @example
  11271. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  11272. @end example
  11273. @item
  11274. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  11275. @example
  11276. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  11277. @end example
  11278. @item
  11279. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  11280. @example
  11281. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  11282. @end example
  11283. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  11284. choice.
  11285. @item
  11286. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  11287. @example
  11288. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  11289. @end example
  11290. @item
  11291. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  11292. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  11293. @example
  11294. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  11295. @end example
  11296. @end itemize
  11297. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  11298. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  11299. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  11300. filtergraph.
  11301. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  11302. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  11303. from that they act the same way.
  11304. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  11305. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  11306. @var{filename} option.
  11307. These filters accept the following options:
  11308. @table @option
  11309. @item commands, c
  11310. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  11311. @item filename, f
  11312. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  11313. filters.
  11314. @end table
  11315. @subsection Commands syntax
  11316. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  11317. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  11318. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  11319. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  11320. interval.
  11321. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  11322. @example
  11323. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  11324. @end example
  11325. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  11326. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  11327. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  11328. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  11329. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  11330. @var{END}.
  11331. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  11332. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  11333. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  11334. @example
  11335. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  11336. @end example
  11337. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  11338. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  11339. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  11340. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  11341. The following flags are recognized:
  11342. @table @option
  11343. @item enter
  11344. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  11345. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  11346. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  11347. current is.
  11348. @item leave
  11349. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  11350. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  11351. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  11352. current is not.
  11353. @end table
  11354. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  11355. assumed.
  11356. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  11357. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  11358. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  11359. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  11360. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  11361. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  11362. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  11363. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  11364. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  11365. follows:
  11366. @example
  11367. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  11368. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  11369. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  11370. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  11371. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  11372. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  11373. @end example
  11374. @subsection Examples
  11375. @itemize
  11376. @item
  11377. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  11378. @example
  11379. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  11380. @end example
  11381. @item
  11382. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  11383. @example
  11384. # show text in the interval 5-10
  11385. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  11386. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  11387. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  11388. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  11389. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  11390. [leave] hue s 1,
  11391. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  11392. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  11393. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  11394. @end example
  11395. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  11396. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  11397. @example
  11398. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  11399. @end example
  11400. @end itemize
  11401. @anchor{setpts}
  11402. @section setpts, asetpts
  11403. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  11404. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  11405. This filter accepts the following options:
  11406. @table @option
  11407. @item expr
  11408. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  11409. @end table
  11410. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  11411. constants:
  11412. @table @option
  11413. @item FRAME_RATE
  11414. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  11415. @item PTS
  11416. The presentation timestamp in input
  11417. @item N
  11418. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  11419. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  11420. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  11421. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  11422. audio)
  11423. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  11424. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  11425. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  11426. The audio sample rate.
  11427. @item STARTPTS
  11428. The PTS of the first frame.
  11429. @item STARTT
  11430. the time in seconds of the first frame
  11431. @item INTERLACED
  11432. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  11433. @item T
  11434. the time in seconds of the current frame
  11435. @item POS
  11436. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  11437. for the current frame
  11438. @item PREV_INPTS
  11439. The previous input PTS.
  11440. @item PREV_INT
  11441. previous input time in seconds
  11442. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  11443. The previous output PTS.
  11444. @item PREV_OUTT
  11445. previous output time in seconds
  11446. @item RTCTIME
  11447. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  11448. instead.
  11449. @item RTCSTART
  11450. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  11451. @item TB
  11452. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  11453. @end table
  11454. @subsection Examples
  11455. @itemize
  11456. @item
  11457. Start counting PTS from zero
  11458. @example
  11459. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  11460. @end example
  11461. @item
  11462. Apply fast motion effect:
  11463. @example
  11464. setpts=0.5*PTS
  11465. @end example
  11466. @item
  11467. Apply slow motion effect:
  11468. @example
  11469. setpts=2.0*PTS
  11470. @end example
  11471. @item
  11472. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  11473. @example
  11474. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  11475. @end example
  11476. @item
  11477. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  11478. @example
  11479. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  11480. @end example
  11481. @item
  11482. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  11483. @example
  11484. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  11485. @end example
  11486. @item
  11487. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  11488. @example
  11489. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  11490. @end example
  11491. @item
  11492. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  11493. @example
  11494. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  11495. @end example
  11496. @end itemize
  11497. @section settb, asettb
  11498. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  11499. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  11500. It accepts the following parameters:
  11501. @table @option
  11502. @item expr, tb
  11503. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  11504. @end table
  11505. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  11506. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  11507. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  11508. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  11509. @subsection Examples
  11510. @itemize
  11511. @item
  11512. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  11513. @example
  11514. settb=expr=1/25
  11515. @end example
  11516. @item
  11517. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  11518. @example
  11519. settb=expr=0.1
  11520. @end example
  11521. @item
  11522. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  11523. @example
  11524. settb=1+0.001
  11525. @end example
  11526. @item
  11527. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  11528. @example
  11529. settb=2*intb
  11530. @end example
  11531. @item
  11532. Set the default timebase value:
  11533. @example
  11534. settb=AVTB
  11535. @end example
  11536. @end itemize
  11537. @section showcqt
  11538. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  11539. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  11540. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  11541. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  11542. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  11543. The filter accepts the following options:
  11544. @table @option
  11545. @item size, s
  11546. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  11547. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11548. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  11549. @item fps, rate, r
  11550. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  11551. @item bar_h
  11552. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  11553. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  11554. @item axis_h
  11555. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  11556. the axis height automatically.
  11557. @item sono_h
  11558. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  11559. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  11560. @item fullhd
  11561. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  11562. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  11563. @item sono_v, volume
  11564. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  11565. @table @option
  11566. @item bar_v
  11567. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  11568. @item frequency, freq, f
  11569. the frequency where it is evaluated
  11570. @item timeclamp, tc
  11571. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  11572. @end table
  11573. and functions:
  11574. @table @option
  11575. @item a_weighting(f)
  11576. A-weighting of equal loudness
  11577. @item b_weighting(f)
  11578. B-weighting of equal loudness
  11579. @item c_weighting(f)
  11580. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  11581. @end table
  11582. Default value is @code{16}.
  11583. @item bar_v, volume2
  11584. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  11585. @table @option
  11586. @item sono_v
  11587. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  11588. @item frequency, freq, f
  11589. the frequency where it is evaluated
  11590. @item timeclamp, tc
  11591. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  11592. @end table
  11593. and functions:
  11594. @table @option
  11595. @item a_weighting(f)
  11596. A-weighting of equal loudness
  11597. @item b_weighting(f)
  11598. B-weighting of equal loudness
  11599. @item c_weighting(f)
  11600. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  11601. @end table
  11602. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  11603. @item sono_g, gamma
  11604. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  11605. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  11606. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  11607. @item bar_g, gamma2
  11608. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  11609. @code{[1, 7]}.
  11610. @item timeclamp, tc
  11611. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  11612. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  11613. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  11614. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  11615. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.1, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  11616. @item basefreq
  11617. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  11618. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  11619. @item endfreq
  11620. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  11621. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  11622. @item coeffclamp
  11623. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  11624. @item tlength
  11625. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  11626. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  11627. It can contain variables:
  11628. @table @option
  11629. @item frequency, freq, f
  11630. the frequency where it is evaluated
  11631. @item timeclamp, tc
  11632. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  11633. @end table
  11634. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  11635. @item count
  11636. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  11637. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  11638. @item fcount
  11639. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  11640. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  11641. @item fontfile
  11642. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  11643. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  11644. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  11645. option instead.
  11646. @item fontcolor
  11647. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  11648. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  11649. @table @option
  11650. @item frequency, freq, f
  11651. the frequency where it is evaluated
  11652. @item timeclamp, tc
  11653. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  11654. @end table
  11655. and functions:
  11656. @table @option
  11657. @item midi(f)
  11658. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  11659. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  11660. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  11661. @end table
  11662. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  11663. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  11664. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  11665. @item axisfile
  11666. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  11667. @var{fontcolor} option.
  11668. @item axis, text
  11669. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  11670. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  11671. Default value is @code{1}.
  11672. @end table
  11673. @subsection Examples
  11674. @itemize
  11675. @item
  11676. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  11677. @example
  11678. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  11679. @end example
  11680. @item
  11681. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  11682. @example
  11683. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  11684. @end example
  11685. @item
  11686. Playing at 1280x720:
  11687. @example
  11688. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  11689. @end example
  11690. @item
  11691. Disable sonogram display:
  11692. @example
  11693. sono_h=0
  11694. @end example
  11695. @item
  11696. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  11697. @example
  11698. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  11699. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  11700. @end example
  11701. @item
  11702. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  11703. @example
  11704. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  11705. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  11706. @end example
  11707. @item
  11708. Custom volume:
  11709. @example
  11710. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  11711. @end example
  11712. @item
  11713. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  11714. @example
  11715. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  11716. @end example
  11717. @item
  11718. Custom tlength equation:
  11719. @example
  11720. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  11721. @end example
  11722. @item
  11723. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  11724. @example
  11725. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  11726. @end example
  11727. @item
  11728. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  11729. @example
  11730. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  11731. @end example
  11732. @end itemize
  11733. @section showfreqs
  11734. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  11735. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  11736. The filter accepts the following options:
  11737. @table @option
  11738. @item size, s
  11739. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11740. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11741. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  11742. @item mode
  11743. Set display mode.
  11744. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  11745. It accepts the following values:
  11746. @table @samp
  11747. @item line
  11748. @item bar
  11749. @item dot
  11750. @end table
  11751. Default is @code{bar}.
  11752. @item ascale
  11753. Set amplitude scale.
  11754. It accepts the following values:
  11755. @table @samp
  11756. @item lin
  11757. Linear scale.
  11758. @item sqrt
  11759. Square root scale.
  11760. @item cbrt
  11761. Cubic root scale.
  11762. @item log
  11763. Logarithmic scale.
  11764. @end table
  11765. Default is @code{log}.
  11766. @item fscale
  11767. Set frequency scale.
  11768. It accepts the following values:
  11769. @table @samp
  11770. @item lin
  11771. Linear scale.
  11772. @item log
  11773. Logarithmic scale.
  11774. @item rlog
  11775. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  11776. @end table
  11777. Default is @code{lin}.
  11778. @item win_size
  11779. Set window size.
  11780. It accepts the following values:
  11781. @table @samp
  11782. @item w16
  11783. @item w32
  11784. @item w64
  11785. @item w128
  11786. @item w256
  11787. @item w512
  11788. @item w1024
  11789. @item w2048
  11790. @item w4096
  11791. @item w8192
  11792. @item w16384
  11793. @item w32768
  11794. @item w65536
  11795. @end table
  11796. Default is @code{w2048}
  11797. @item win_func
  11798. Set windowing function.
  11799. It accepts the following values:
  11800. @table @samp
  11801. @item rect
  11802. @item bartlett
  11803. @item hanning
  11804. @item hamming
  11805. @item blackman
  11806. @item welch
  11807. @item flattop
  11808. @item bharris
  11809. @item bnuttall
  11810. @item bhann
  11811. @item sine
  11812. @item nuttall
  11813. @item lanczos
  11814. @item gauss
  11815. @item tukey
  11816. @end table
  11817. Default is @code{hanning}.
  11818. @item overlap
  11819. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  11820. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  11821. @item averaging
  11822. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  11823. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  11824. @item colors
  11825. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  11826. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  11827. by white color.
  11828. @item cmode
  11829. Set channel display mode.
  11830. It accepts the following values:
  11831. @table @samp
  11832. @item combined
  11833. @item separate
  11834. @end table
  11835. Default is @code{combined}.
  11836. @end table
  11837. @anchor{showspectrum}
  11838. @section showspectrum
  11839. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  11840. spectrum.
  11841. The filter accepts the following options:
  11842. @table @option
  11843. @item size, s
  11844. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11845. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11846. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  11847. @item slide
  11848. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  11849. It accepts the following values:
  11850. @table @samp
  11851. @item replace
  11852. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  11853. @item scroll
  11854. the samples scroll from right to left
  11855. @item rscroll
  11856. the samples scroll from left to right
  11857. @item fullframe
  11858. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  11859. @end table
  11860. Default value is @code{replace}.
  11861. @item mode
  11862. Specify display mode.
  11863. It accepts the following values:
  11864. @table @samp
  11865. @item combined
  11866. all channels are displayed in the same row
  11867. @item separate
  11868. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  11869. @end table
  11870. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  11871. @item color
  11872. Specify display color mode.
  11873. It accepts the following values:
  11874. @table @samp
  11875. @item channel
  11876. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  11877. @item intensity
  11878. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  11879. @item rainbow
  11880. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  11881. @item moreland
  11882. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  11883. @item nebulae
  11884. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  11885. @item fire
  11886. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  11887. @item fiery
  11888. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  11889. @item fruit
  11890. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  11891. @item cool
  11892. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  11893. @end table
  11894. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  11895. @item scale
  11896. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  11897. It accepts the following values:
  11898. @table @samp
  11899. @item lin
  11900. linear
  11901. @item sqrt
  11902. square root, default
  11903. @item cbrt
  11904. cubic root
  11905. @item 4thrt
  11906. 4th root
  11907. @item 5thrt
  11908. 5th root
  11909. @item log
  11910. logarithmic
  11911. @end table
  11912. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  11913. @item saturation
  11914. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  11915. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  11916. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  11917. Default value is @code{1}.
  11918. @item win_func
  11919. Set window function.
  11920. It accepts the following values:
  11921. @table @samp
  11922. @item rect
  11923. @item bartlett
  11924. @item hann
  11925. @item hanning
  11926. @item hamming
  11927. @item blackman
  11928. @item welch
  11929. @item flattop
  11930. @item bharris
  11931. @item bnuttall
  11932. @item bhann
  11933. @item sine
  11934. @item nuttall
  11935. @item lanczos
  11936. @item gauss
  11937. @item tukey
  11938. @end table
  11939. Default value is @code{hann}.
  11940. @item orientation
  11941. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  11942. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  11943. @item overlap
  11944. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  11945. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  11946. window function currently used.
  11947. @item gain
  11948. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  11949. Default value is @code{1}.
  11950. @item data
  11951. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  11952. @end table
  11953. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  11954. section.
  11955. @subsection Examples
  11956. @itemize
  11957. @item
  11958. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  11959. @example
  11960. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  11961. @end example
  11962. @item
  11963. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  11964. @example
  11965. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  11966. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  11967. @end example
  11968. @end itemize
  11969. @section showspectrumpic
  11970. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  11971. spectrum.
  11972. The filter accepts the following options:
  11973. @table @option
  11974. @item size, s
  11975. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11976. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11977. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  11978. @item mode
  11979. Specify display mode.
  11980. It accepts the following values:
  11981. @table @samp
  11982. @item combined
  11983. all channels are displayed in the same row
  11984. @item separate
  11985. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  11986. @end table
  11987. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  11988. @item color
  11989. Specify display color mode.
  11990. It accepts the following values:
  11991. @table @samp
  11992. @item channel
  11993. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  11994. @item intensity
  11995. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  11996. @item rainbow
  11997. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  11998. @item moreland
  11999. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  12000. @item nebulae
  12001. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  12002. @item fire
  12003. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  12004. @item fiery
  12005. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  12006. @item fruit
  12007. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  12008. @item cool
  12009. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  12010. @end table
  12011. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  12012. @item scale
  12013. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  12014. It accepts the following values:
  12015. @table @samp
  12016. @item lin
  12017. linear
  12018. @item sqrt
  12019. square root, default
  12020. @item cbrt
  12021. cubic root
  12022. @item 4thrt
  12023. 4th root
  12024. @item 5thrt
  12025. 5th root
  12026. @item log
  12027. logarithmic
  12028. @end table
  12029. Default value is @samp{log}.
  12030. @item saturation
  12031. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  12032. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  12033. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  12034. Default value is @code{1}.
  12035. @item win_func
  12036. Set window function.
  12037. It accepts the following values:
  12038. @table @samp
  12039. @item rect
  12040. @item bartlett
  12041. @item hann
  12042. @item hanning
  12043. @item hamming
  12044. @item blackman
  12045. @item welch
  12046. @item flattop
  12047. @item bharris
  12048. @item bnuttall
  12049. @item bhann
  12050. @item sine
  12051. @item nuttall
  12052. @item lanczos
  12053. @item gauss
  12054. @item tukey
  12055. @end table
  12056. Default value is @code{hann}.
  12057. @item orientation
  12058. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  12059. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  12060. @item gain
  12061. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  12062. Default value is @code{1}.
  12063. @item legend
  12064. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  12065. @end table
  12066. @subsection Examples
  12067. @itemize
  12068. @item
  12069. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  12070. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  12071. @example
  12072. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  12073. @end example
  12074. @end itemize
  12075. @section showvolume
  12076. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  12077. The filter accepts the following options:
  12078. @table @option
  12079. @item rate, r
  12080. Set video rate.
  12081. @item b
  12082. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  12083. @item w
  12084. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 1080]. Default is 400.
  12085. @item h
  12086. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 100]. Default is 20.
  12087. @item f
  12088. Set fade, allowed range is [0.001, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  12089. @item c
  12090. Set volume color expression.
  12091. The expression can use the following variables:
  12092. @table @option
  12093. @item VOLUME
  12094. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  12095. @item CHANNEL
  12096. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  12097. @end table
  12098. @item t
  12099. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  12100. @item v
  12101. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  12102. @end table
  12103. @section showwaves
  12104. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  12105. The filter accepts the following options:
  12106. @table @option
  12107. @item size, s
  12108. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12109. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12110. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  12111. @item mode
  12112. Set display mode.
  12113. Available values are:
  12114. @table @samp
  12115. @item point
  12116. Draw a point for each sample.
  12117. @item line
  12118. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  12119. @item p2p
  12120. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  12121. @item cline
  12122. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  12123. @end table
  12124. Default value is @code{point}.
  12125. @item n
  12126. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  12127. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  12128. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  12129. is not explicitly specified.
  12130. @item rate, r
  12131. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  12132. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  12133. @item split_channels
  12134. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  12135. @item colors
  12136. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  12137. @item scale
  12138. Set amplitude scale. Can be linear @code{lin} or logarithmic @code{log}.
  12139. Default is linear.
  12140. @end table
  12141. @subsection Examples
  12142. @itemize
  12143. @item
  12144. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  12145. at the same time:
  12146. @example
  12147. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  12148. @end example
  12149. @item
  12150. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  12151. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  12152. @example
  12153. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  12154. @end example
  12155. @end itemize
  12156. @section showwavespic
  12157. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  12158. The filter accepts the following options:
  12159. @table @option
  12160. @item size, s
  12161. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12162. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12163. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  12164. @item split_channels
  12165. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  12166. @item colors
  12167. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  12168. @item scale
  12169. Set amplitude scale. Can be linear @code{lin} or logarithmic @code{log}.
  12170. Default is linear.
  12171. @end table
  12172. @subsection Examples
  12173. @itemize
  12174. @item
  12175. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  12176. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  12177. @example
  12178. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  12179. @end example
  12180. @item
  12181. Colorize the waveform with colorchannelmixer. This example will make
  12182. the waveform a green color approximately RGB(66,217,150). Additional
  12183. channels will be shades of this color.
  12184. @example
  12185. ffmpeg -i audio.mp3 -filter_complex "showwavespic,colorchannelmixer=rr=66/255:gg=217/255:bb=150/255" waveform.png
  12186. @end example
  12187. @end itemize
  12188. @section spectrumsynth
  12189. Sythesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  12190. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  12191. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  12192. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  12193. This filter is primarly created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  12194. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  12195. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  12196. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  12197. its just recreated from random noise.
  12198. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  12199. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  12200. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  12201. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  12202. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  12203. The filter accepts the following options:
  12204. @table @option
  12205. @item sample_rate
  12206. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  12207. spectrum was generated may differ.
  12208. @item channels
  12209. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  12210. @item scale
  12211. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  12212. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  12213. @item slide
  12214. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  12215. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  12216. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  12217. @item win_func
  12218. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  12219. @item overlap
  12220. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  12221. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  12222. @item orientation
  12223. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  12224. Default is @code{vertical}.
  12225. @end table
  12226. @subsection Examples
  12227. @itemize
  12228. @item
  12229. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  12230. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  12231. @example
  12232. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  12233. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  12234. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  12235. @end example
  12236. @end itemize
  12237. @section split, asplit
  12238. Split input into several identical outputs.
  12239. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  12240. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  12241. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  12242. @subsection Examples
  12243. @itemize
  12244. @item
  12245. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  12246. @example
  12247. [in] split [out0][out1]
  12248. @end example
  12249. @item
  12250. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  12251. outputs, like in:
  12252. @example
  12253. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  12254. @end example
  12255. @item
  12256. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  12257. one padded:
  12258. @example
  12259. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  12260. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  12261. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  12262. @end example
  12263. @item
  12264. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  12265. @example
  12266. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  12267. @end example
  12268. @end itemize
  12269. @section zmq, azmq
  12270. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  12271. filters in the filtergraph.
  12272. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  12273. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  12274. audio filters.
  12275. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  12276. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  12277. For more information about libzmq see:
  12278. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  12279. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  12280. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  12281. @option{bind_address} option.
  12282. The received message must be in the form:
  12283. @example
  12284. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  12285. @end example
  12286. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  12287. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  12288. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  12289. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  12290. given @var{COMMAND}.
  12291. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  12292. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  12293. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  12294. @example
  12295. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  12296. @var{MESSAGE}
  12297. @end example
  12298. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  12299. @subsection Examples
  12300. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  12301. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  12302. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}
  12303. @example
  12304. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  12305. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  12306. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  12307. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  12308. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  12309. [bg+l][r] overlay=x=100 "
  12310. @end example
  12311. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  12312. command can be used:
  12313. @example
  12314. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  12315. @end example
  12316. To change the right side:
  12317. @example
  12318. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  12319. @end example
  12320. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  12321. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  12322. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  12323. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  12324. @section amovie
  12325. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  12326. stream by default.
  12327. @anchor{movie}
  12328. @section movie
  12329. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  12330. It accepts the following parameters:
  12331. @table @option
  12332. @item filename
  12333. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  12334. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  12335. @item format_name, f
  12336. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  12337. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  12338. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  12339. @item seek_point, sp
  12340. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  12341. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  12342. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  12343. postfix. The default value is "0".
  12344. @item streams, s
  12345. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  12346. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  12347. same order. The syntax is explained in the ``Stream specifiers''
  12348. section in the ffmpeg manual. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  12349. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  12350. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  12351. @item stream_index, si
  12352. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  12353. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  12354. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  12355. audio instead of video.
  12356. @item loop
  12357. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  12358. If the value is less than 1, the stream will be read again and again.
  12359. Default value is "1".
  12360. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  12361. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  12362. @end table
  12363. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  12364. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  12365. @example
  12366. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  12367. ^
  12368. |
  12369. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  12370. @end example
  12371. @subsection Examples
  12372. @itemize
  12373. @item
  12374. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  12375. on top of the input labelled "in":
  12376. @example
  12377. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  12378. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  12379. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  12380. @end example
  12381. @item
  12382. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  12383. labelled "in":
  12384. @example
  12385. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  12386. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  12387. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  12388. @end example
  12389. @item
  12390. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  12391. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  12392. connected to the pad named "audio":
  12393. @example
  12394. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  12395. @end example
  12396. @end itemize
  12397. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES